blob: e769350f86267a15c2e94aba694456c4f93f8d8e [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaueaded982022-12-01 15:25:34 +01005 version 2.8
Willy Tarreauc80560b2023-02-14 16:55:17 +01006 2023/02/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001018.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
1038.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001239.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
193This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
194streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200198
199HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200200head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200201streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
202other streams.
203
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
205connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
206leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100207start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
208processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
209waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200210
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200211HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100212 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
213 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100214 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100215 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200216 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100217
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219
2201.2. HTTP request
221-----------------
222
223First, let's consider this HTTP request :
224
225 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100226 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
228 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
229 3 User-agent: my small browser
230 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
231 5 Accept: image/png
232
233
2341.2.1. The Request line
235-----------------------
236
237Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
238
239 - a METHOD : GET
240 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
242
243All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
244which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
245followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
246is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
247desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
248the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
249
250The URI itself can have several forms :
251
252 - A "relative URI" :
253
254 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
257 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
258
259 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
260
261 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
262
263 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
264 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
265 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
266 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
267 must accept this form too.
268
269 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
270 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
271 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
274 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
275 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
276 other protocols too.
277
278In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
279mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
280on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
281It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
282specific to the language, framework or application in use.
283
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100284HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100285assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.2.2. The request headers
289--------------------------
290
291The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
292beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
293an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
294Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
295values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
296encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
297the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
298define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
299
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100300Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100302"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200303as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
304normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
305representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
306HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307
308The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
309that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
310is one valid form of empty line.
311
312Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
313headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
314about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
315application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
316
317Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000318 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
320 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
321 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
322
323
3241.3. HTTP response
325------------------
326
327An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
328messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
329
330 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100331 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
333 2 Content-length: 350
334 3 Content-Type: text/html
335
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
337codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
338response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100339continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
340the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
341following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
342sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
343(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
344correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
345such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
346state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400347over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100348if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
349information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003521.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353------------------------
354
355Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
356
357 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
358 - a status code : 200
359 - a reason : OK
360
361The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100362 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
363 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
364 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
365 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
366 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000368Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100369"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
371messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
372or "Authentication Required".
373
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100374HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375
376 Code When / reason
377 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
378 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
379 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
380 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100381 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
382 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 400 for an invalid or too large request
384 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
385 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100387 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100389 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
390 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400391 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200392 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400393 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100394 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200395 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200396 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200397 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
398 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
399 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
400
401The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4024.2).
403
404
4051.3.2. The response headers
406---------------------------
407
408Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
409the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
410details.
411
412
4132. Configuring HAProxy
414----------------------
415
4162.1. Configuration file format
417------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
419HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
420
421 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700423 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100424 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200425
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100426The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
427a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100428
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100429 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
430
431 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
432
433 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
434 tab characters
435
436 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
437 keyword sequences listed in this document
438
439 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
440 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
441 parts of the configuration, or expressions
442
443 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
444 are supported
445
446 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
447 section
448
449This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
450generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
451figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
452
453First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
454the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
455a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
456word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
457follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
458the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
459the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
460the parts that need to be addressed.
461
462A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
463requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
464extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
465the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
466section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
467section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
468not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
469
470A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
471each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
472a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
473start a new one.
474
475Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
476that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
477applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
478"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
479processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
480ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
481which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
482In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
483of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
484identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
485such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4862, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
487
488 listen foo
489 bind :80
490
491 listen bar
492 bind :81
493
494Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
495spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
496of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
497following configurations are strictly equivalent:
498
499 global#this is the global section
500 daemon#daemonize
501 frontend foo
502 mode http # or tcp
503
504and:
505
506 global
507 daemon
508
509 # this is the public web frontend
510 frontend foo
511 mode http
512
513The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
514new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
515other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
516section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
517section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
518at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
519
520Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
521are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
522editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
523support automatic indent.
524
525In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
526positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
527modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
528anymore, and is not recommended.
529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200530
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005312.2. Quoting and escaping
532-------------------------
533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
535that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
536possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
537in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
538('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
541very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
542the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
543also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
544delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
545word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
546remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100548If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
549(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
550
551Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
552backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200553
554 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
555 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
556 \\ to use a backslash
557 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
558 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
559
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100560In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
561C-language representation:
562
563 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
564 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
565 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
566 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
567
568Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
569or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
570of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200571
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100572 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200573 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
574 # hash as a comment start
575
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
577evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
578dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
579backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200580
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100581Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
582character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
583is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
586entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
587name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
588represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
589hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100591 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
592 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
593 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
594 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
595 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
596 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
597 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
598 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
599 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
600 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
601 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200602
603 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200605 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
606 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
607 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
608 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
609 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
610
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100611There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
612necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
613by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
614they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
615escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
616characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
617case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
618if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
619own quotes.
620
621The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600622quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500623not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100624quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
625
626Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
627arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
628
629 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
631
632Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
633"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
634cannot write:
635
636 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
637
638because we would like the string to cut like this:
639
640 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
641 |---------|----|-|
642 arg1 _/ / /
643 arg2 __________/ /
644 arg3 ______________/
645
646but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
647parenthesis then garbage:
648
649 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
650 |--------|--------|
651 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
652 trailing garbage _________/
653
654The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
655quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
656processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
657this word:
658
659 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
660 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
661 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
662
663So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
664still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
665the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
666the second level:
667
668 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
669 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
670 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
671 |---------||----|-|
672 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
673 arg2=blah ___________/ /
674 arg3=g _______________/
675
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500676Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100677double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
678
679 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
680 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
681 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
682 |---------||----|-|
683 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
684 arg2 ___________/ /
685 arg3 _______________/
686
687When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
688appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
689string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
690thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
691
692 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
693 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
694 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
695 |-------------| |-----||-|
696 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
697 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
698 arg3 ______________________/
699
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400700Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600701that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100702quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
703single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
704level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
705
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600706Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
707if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
708or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
709
710 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
711 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
712 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
713
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100714When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
715double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600716and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100717a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
718a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
719the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
720regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
721around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
722more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200723
724
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007252.3. Environment variables
726--------------------------
727
728HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
729interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
730configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
731optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
732shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200733underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
734list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
735arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100736before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
737use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
738next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
739existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200740
741 Example:
742
743 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
744
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100745 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200746
747 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
748
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200749Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
750file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200751
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200752* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
753 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
754
755* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
756 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
757 directory.
758
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +0100759* HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT: contains the value of the default HTTP log format as
760 defined in section 8.2.3 "HTTP log format". It can be used to override the
761 default log format without having to copy the whole original definition.
762
763 Example:
764 # Add the rule that gave the final verdict to the log
765 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT} lr=last_rule_file:last_rule_line"
766
767* HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for HTTPS log
768 format as defined in section 8.2.4 "HTTPS log format".
769
770* HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for TCP log format
771 as defined in section 8.2.2 "TCP log format".
772
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200773* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
774
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500775* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200776 processes, separated by semicolons.
777
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500778* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200779 CLI, separated by semicolons.
780
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200781In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
782regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
783only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
784
785* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
786
787* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
788 starting at one.
789
790* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
791 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
792 first section.
793
794These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
795if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
796section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
797"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
798proxies.
799
800This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
801logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
802to name some config objects like servers for example.
803
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200804See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200805
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100806
8072.4. Conditional blocks
808-----------------------
809
810It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
811some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
812ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
813configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
814versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
815preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
816text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
817lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
818switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
819are defined to form conditional blocks:
820
821 - .if <condition>
822 - .elif <condition>
823 - .else
824 - .endif
825
826The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
827as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
828matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
829there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
830only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
831".elif" of a block.
832
833Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
834ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
835as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
836
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200837Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
838See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
839
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200840The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
841expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100842
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100843 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
844 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200845 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200846 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530847 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
848 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200849 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
850 from left to right until one returns false
851 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
852 from right to left until one returns true
853
854Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
855operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200856
857The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
858
859 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
860 exists, regardless of its contents
861
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200862 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
863 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
864 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
865
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200866 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
867 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
868
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200869 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
870 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
871 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
872 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
873
874 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
875 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
876 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
877 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
878
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200879Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100880
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200881 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
882 listen mwcli_px
883 bind :1111
884 ...
885 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100886
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200887 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
888 bind :80
889 .endif
890
891 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200892 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200893 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200894 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200895 .endif
896
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200897 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200898 bind :443 ssl crt ...
899 .endif
900
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200901 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
902 profiling.memory on
903 .endif
904
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200905 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
906 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
907 .endif
908
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200909Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100910
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200911 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100912 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
913 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
914 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
915
916Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
917"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
918fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
919provide advice to the user.
920
921Example:
922
923 .if "${A}"
924 .if "${B}"
925 .notice "A=1, B=1"
926 .elif "${C}"
927 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
928 .elif "${D}"
929 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
930 .else
931 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
932 .endif
933 .else
934 .notice "A=0"
935 .endif
936
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200937 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
938 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
939
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100940
9412.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200942----------------
943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100944Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100945values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
946otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
947numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
948for every keyword. Supported units are :
949
950 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
951 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
952 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
953 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
954 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
955 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
956
957
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009582.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200959-------------
960
961 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
962 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
963 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
964 global
965 daemon
966 maxconn 256
967
968 defaults
969 mode http
970 timeout connect 5000ms
971 timeout client 50000ms
972 timeout server 50000ms
973
974 frontend http-in
975 bind *:80
976 default_backend servers
977
978 backend servers
979 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
980
981
982 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
983 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
984 global
985 daemon
986 maxconn 256
987
988 defaults
989 mode http
990 timeout connect 5000ms
991 timeout client 50000ms
992 timeout server 50000ms
993
994 listen http-in
995 bind *:80
996 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
997
998
999Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
1000
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +01001001 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001002
1003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010043. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005--------------------
1006
1007Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
1008are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
1009of them have command-line equivalents.
1010
1011The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
1012
1013 * Process management and security
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001014 - 51degrees-allow-unmatched
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001015 - 51degrees-cache-size
1016 - 51degrees-data-file
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001017 - 51degrees-difference
1018 - 51degrees-drift
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001019 - 51degrees-property-name-list
1020 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001021 - 51degrees-use-performance-graph
1022 - 51degrees-use-predictive-graph
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001023 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001025 - cluster-secret
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001026 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001027 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001029 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001030 - description
1031 - deviceatlas-json-file
1032 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001033 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001034 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001035 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001036 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001037 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001039 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001040 - group
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001041 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1042 - h1-case-adjust
1043 - h1-case-adjust-file
1044 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001045 - hard-stop-after
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001046 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1047 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1048 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1049 - httpclient.ssl.verify
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001050 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001051 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001052 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001053 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001054 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001055 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001056 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001057 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001058 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001059 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001060 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001061 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001062 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001063 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001065 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001066 - presetenv
1067 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001068 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001069 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001070 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001071 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001072 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001073 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001074 - ssl-default-bind-options
1075 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001076 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001077 - ssl-default-server-options
1078 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001079 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001080 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001081 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001082 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001083 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001084 - stats
1085 - strict-limits
1086 - uid
1087 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001088 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001089 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001090 - user
1091 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001092 - wurfl-data-file
1093 - wurfl-information-list
1094 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001095
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001097 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001098 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001099 - maxcompcpuusage
1100 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001101 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001102 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001103 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001104 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001105 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001106 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001107 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001108 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001110 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001111 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001112 - nokqueue
1113 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001114 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001115 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001116 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001117 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001118 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001119 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001120 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001121 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001122 - tune.buffers.limit
1123 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001124 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001125 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Fauletd4eaa8a2023-02-14 15:37:14 +01001126 - tune.fast-forward
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001127 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001128 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001129 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001130 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001131 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001132 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001133 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001134 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001135 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001136 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001137 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001138 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001139 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1140 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001141 - tune.maxaccept
1142 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001143 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01001144 - tune.memory.hot-size
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001145 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001146 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001147 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001148 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1149 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001150 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001151 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001152 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01001153 - tune.quic.max-frame-loss
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001154 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01001155 - tune.quic.socket-owner
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001156 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1157 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001158 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001159 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001160 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001161 - tune.sndbuf.client
1162 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01001163 - tune.stick-counters
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001164 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001165 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1166 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
1167 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001168 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1169 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001170 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001171 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1172 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001173 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001174 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001175 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001176 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1177 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1178 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001179 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1180 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001181
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001182 * Debugging
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02001183 - anonkey
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001184 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001185 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001186
1187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011883.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001189------------------------------------
1190
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100119151degrees-data-file <file path>
1192 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1193 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1194
1195 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001196 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001197
119851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1199 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1200 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1201 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1202
1203 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001204 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001205
120651degrees-property-separator <char>
1207 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1208 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1209
1210 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001211 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001212
121351degrees-cache-size <number>
1214 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1215 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1216 By default, this cache is disabled.
1217
1218 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001219 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001220
122151degrees-use-performance-graph { on | off }
1222 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the performance graph in
1223 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1224
1225 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001226 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001227
122851degrees-use-predictive-graph { on | off }
1229 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the predictive graph in
1230 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1231
1232 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001233 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001234
123551degrees-drift <number>
1236 Sets the drift value that a detection can allow.
1237
1238 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001239 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001240
124151degrees-difference <number>
1242 Sets the difference value that a detection can allow.
1243
1244 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001245 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001246
124751degrees-allow-unmatched { on | off }
1248 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of unmatched nodes in the
1249 detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1250
1251 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001252 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001253
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001254ca-base <dir>
1255 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001256 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1257 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1258 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001259
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001260chroot <jail dir>
1261 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1262 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1263 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1264 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1265 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001266 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001267
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001268close-spread-time <time>
1269 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1270 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1271 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1272 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1273 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1274 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1275 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1276 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001277 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1278 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1279 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1280 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1281 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001282
1283 Arguments :
1284 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001285 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1286 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001287
1288 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1289 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1290 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1291
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001292 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001293
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001294cluster-secret <secret>
1295 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1296 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1297 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1298 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
Amaury Denoyelle28ea31c2022-11-14 16:18:46 +01001299 tokens.
1300
1301 If this parameter is not set, a random value will be selected on process
1302 startup. This allows to use features which rely on it, albeit with some
1303 limitations.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001304
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001305cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1306 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1307 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1308 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1309 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1310 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001311
1312 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1313
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001314 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001315 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1316 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1317 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1318 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1319 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1320 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1321 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
1322 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside
1323 of Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1324 either 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the
1325 processes or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously,
1326 multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will
1327 replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001328
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001329 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1330 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1331 on the machine's word size.
1332
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001333 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1334 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001335 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1336 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001337 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001338 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1339 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001340
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001341 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1342 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1343 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1344 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1345 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001346
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001347 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001348 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001349 # first 4 CPUs
1350
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001351 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1352 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001353 # word size.
1354
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001355 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001356 # and so on.
1357 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1358 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1359 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1360
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001361 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1362 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1363 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1364 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001365
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001366 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1367 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1368 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001369
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001370 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1371 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1372 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1373 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1374 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1375
1376 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1377 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1378 # group may have more than 64 threads.
1379 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39 80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1380 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39 80-119
1381 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79 120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1382 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79 120-159
1383
1384
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001385crt-base <dir>
1386 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001387 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1388 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001389
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001390daemon
1391 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1392 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001393 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1394 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001395
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001396default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001397 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001398 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1399 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1400 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1401 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1402 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1403 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1404 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1405 not start with a slash ('/'):
1406 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1407 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1408
1409 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1410 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1411 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1412 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1413 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1414 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1415 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1416 each of them.
1417
1418 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1419 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1420 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1421 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1422 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1423 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1424 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1425 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1426
1427 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1428 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001429 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001430 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1431 made easily relocatable.
1432
1433 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1434 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1435 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1436 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1437 consistent across all configuration files.
1438
1439 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1440 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1441 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1442 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1443 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1444 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1445 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1446 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1447
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001448description <text>
1449 Add a text that describes the instance.
1450
1451 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1452 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1453 "<" and ">" characters.
1454
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001455deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1456 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001457 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001458
1459deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001460 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001461 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1462
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001463deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001464 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1465 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1466 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001467
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001468deviceatlas-separator <char>
1469 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1470 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1471
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001472expose-experimental-directives
1473 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1474 the config file will be rejected.
1475
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001476external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001477 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1478 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001479 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1480 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1481 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1482 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1483 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001484
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001485fd-hard-limit <number>
1486 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1487 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1488 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1489 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1490 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1491 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1492 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1493 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1494 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1495 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1496 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1497 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1498
1499 global
1500 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1501 fd-hard-limit 50000
1502
1503 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001505gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001506 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001507 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1508 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001509 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001510 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001511 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001512
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001513grace <time>
1514 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1515
1516 Arguments :
1517 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1518 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1519 soft-stop operation.
1520
1521 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1522 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1523 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1524 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1525 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1526 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1527 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1528 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1529 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1530
1531 Example:
1532
1533 global
1534 grace 10s
1535
1536 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1537 frontend ext-check
1538 bind :9999
1539 monitor-uri /ext-check
1540 monitor fail if { stopping }
1541
1542 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1543 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1544 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1545 SIGUSR1 signal.
1546
1547 Example:
1548
1549 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1550 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1551 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1552 frontend ext-check
1553 bind :9999
1554 monitor-uri /ext-check
1555 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1556
1557 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1558
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001559group <group name>
1560 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1561 See also "gid" and "user".
1562
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001563h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1564 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1565
1566 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1567 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1568 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1569 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1570 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1571 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1572 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1573
1574 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1575 option may be set.
1576
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001577h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1578 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1579 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1580 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1581 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001582 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001583 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1584 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1585 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1586 specified in a proxy.
1587
1588 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1589 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1590 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1591 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1592 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1593 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1594 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1595
1596 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1597 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1598 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1599 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1600 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1601
1602 Example:
1603 global
1604 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1605
1606 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1607 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1608
1609h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1610 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1611 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1612 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1613 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1614 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1615 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1616 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1617 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1618
1619 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1620 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1621 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1622
1623 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1624 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1625
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001626h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1627 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1628 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1629 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1630 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1631 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1632 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1633 the keyword with "no'.
1634
1635hard-stop-after <time>
1636 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1637
1638 Arguments :
1639 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1640 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1641 SIGUSR1 signal.
1642
1643 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1644 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1645 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1646
1647 Example:
1648 global
1649 hard-stop-after 30s
1650
1651 See also: grace
1652
1653httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1654 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1655 to resolve.
1656
1657 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1658 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1659
1660 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1661 configuration error if it fails to load.
1662
1663httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1664 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1665 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1666 option is "ipv6".
1667
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001668httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1669 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1670 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1671 server line.
1672
1673 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1674 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1675 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1676
1677 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1678 configuration error if it fails.
1679
1680httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1681 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1682 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1683
1684 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1685 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1686
1687 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1688 configuration error if it fails.
1689
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001690insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001691 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001692 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1693 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1694 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1695 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1696 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1697 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1698 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001699 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001700 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1701 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1702 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1703 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1704 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1705 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1706 disable it.
1707
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001708insecure-setuid-wanted
1709 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1710 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1711 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1712 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001713 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001714 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001715 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001716 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1717 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001718 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001719 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1720 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1721 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1722 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1723
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001724issuers-chain-path <dir>
1725 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1726 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1727 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001728 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001729 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1730 "issuers-chain-path".
1731 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1732 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1733 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1734 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1735 will share the chain in memory.
1736
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001737localpeer <name>
1738 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1739 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1740 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1741 the configuration parsing.
1742
1743 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1744 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1745
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001746log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001747 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001748 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001749 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001750 configured with "log global".
1751
1752 <address> can be one of:
1753
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001754 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001755 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1756 port).
1757
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001758 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1759 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1760 port).
1761
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001762 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001763 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1764 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001765 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001766
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001767 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1768 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1769 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1770 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1771 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1772 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1773 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1774 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1775 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1776 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001777 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001778 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1779 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1780 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001781 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1782 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001783
1784 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1785 "fd@2", see above.
1786
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001787 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1788 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1789 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1790 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1791 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1792
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001793 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1794 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001795
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001796 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1797 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1798 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1799 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1800 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1801 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1802 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1803 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1804 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1805 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001806 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1807 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001808
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001809 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1810 one of the following :
1811
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001812 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1813 field is stripped. This is the default.
1814 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1815 rfc3164.
1816
1817 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001818 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1819
1820 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1821 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1822
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001823 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1824 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1825 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1826 designed to be used with a local log server.
1827
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001828 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1829 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1830 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1831 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1832 logger consumes.
1833
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001834 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1835 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1836 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1837 used with a local log server.
1838
1839 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1840 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1841 designed to be used with a local log server.
1842
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001843 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1844 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1845 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1846 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1847
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001848 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1849 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1850 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1851 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1852 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1853
1854 <sample_size>
1855 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1856 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1857 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1858 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1859 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1860
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001861 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001862
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001863 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1864 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1865 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1866
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001867 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1868 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1869 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1870 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001871
1872 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001873 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1874 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1875 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1876 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1877 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1878 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001879
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001880 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001881
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001882log-send-hostname [<string>]
1883 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1884 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1885 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1886 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1887 the logs.
1888
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001889log-tag <string>
1890 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1891 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1892 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001893 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001894
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001895lua-load <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001896 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1897 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1898 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1899 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1900 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1901 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001902 used multiple times.
1903
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001904 args are available in the lua file using the code below in the body of the
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001905 file. Do not forget that Lua arrays start at index 1. A "local" variable
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001906 declared in a file is available in the entire file and not available on
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001907 other files.
1908
1909 local args = table.pack(...)
1910
1911lua-load-per-thread <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001912 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1913 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1914 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1915 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1916 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1917 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1918 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1919 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1920 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1921 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1922 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1923 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1924 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1925 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1926 times.
1927
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001928 See lua-load for usage of args.
1929
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001930lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1931 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1932 variable.
1933 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1934 to "path".
1935
1936 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1937 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1938 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1939 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1940 will be checked earlier.
1941
1942 As an example by specifying the following path:
1943
1944 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1945 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1946
1947 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1948 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1949 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1950 paths if that does not exist either.
1951
1952 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1953 documentation.
1954
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001955master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001956 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1957 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1958 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001959 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001960 or daemon mode.
1961
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001962 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1963 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1964 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1965 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1966 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001967
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001968 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001969
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001970mworker-max-reloads <number>
1971 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001972 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001973 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1974 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1975 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1976
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001977nbthread <number>
1978 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001979 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1980 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1981 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1982 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1983 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1984 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1985 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001986
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01001987no-quic
1988 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
1989 change without deprecation in the future.
1990
1991 Disable QUIC transport protocol. All the QUIC listeners will still be created.
1992 But they will not bind their addresses. Hence, no QUIC traffic will be
1993 processed by haproxy. See also "quic_enabled" sample fetch.
1994
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001995numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01001996 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
1997 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
1998 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
1999 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
2000 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
2001 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
2002 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
2003 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
2004 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
2005 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002006
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002007pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09002008 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
2009 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
2010 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
2011 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002012
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02002013pp2-never-send-local
2014 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
2015 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
2016 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
2017 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
2018 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
2019 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
2020 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
2021 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
2022 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
2023 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
2024 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
2025
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002026presetenv <name> <value>
2027 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2028 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
2029 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
2030 and "unsetenv".
2031
2032resetenv [<name> ...]
2033 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
2034 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
2035 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
2036 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
2037 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
2038 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
2039 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
2040 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
2041
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002042server-state-base <directory>
2043 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002044 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
2045 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02002046
2047server-state-file <file>
2048 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
2049 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
2050 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
2051 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
2052 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
2053 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
2054 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
2055 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002056 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
2057 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002058
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002059set-dumpable
2060 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
2061 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
2062 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
2063 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
2064 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
2065 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
2066 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
2067 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
2068 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
2069 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
2070 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
2071 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
2072 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
2073 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
2074 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2075 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
2076 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
2077 leaves a core where expected when dying.
2078
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002079set-var <var-name> <expr>
2080 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
2081 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2082 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2083 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
2084 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
2085 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002086 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002087 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
2088 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2089
2090 Example:
2091 global
2092 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
2093 set-var proc.prio int(100)
2094 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
2095
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002096set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
2097 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
2098 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2099 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2100 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
2101 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
2102 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
2103 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
2104 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
2105 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2106 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
2107
2108 Example:
2109 global
2110 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
2111 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
2112
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002113setenv <name> <value>
2114 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2115 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
2116 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
2117 and "unsetenv".
2118
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002119ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2120 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2121 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002122 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002123 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002124 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2125 information and recommendations see e.g.
2126 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2127 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2128 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2129 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002130
2131ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2132 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2133 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
2134 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2135 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2136 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002137 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2138 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2139 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002140 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002141
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002142ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2143 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2144 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2145 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2146 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2147 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2148
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002149ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2150 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2151 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2152 keyword to see available options.
2153
2154 Example:
2155 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002156 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002157
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002158ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2160 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002161 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002162 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002163 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2164 information and recommendations see e.g.
2165 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2166 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2167 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2168 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2169 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002170
2171ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2172 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2173 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2174 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2175 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2176 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002177 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2178 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2179 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2180 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002181
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002182ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2183 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2184 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2185 keyword to see available options.
2186
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002187ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2188 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2189 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2190 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002191 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002192 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002193 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002194 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2195 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2196 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2197 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002198 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2199 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2200 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2201
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002202ssl-propquery <query>
2203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2204 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2205 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2206 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2207 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2208 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2209 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2210 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2211 was not found.
2212
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002213ssl-provider <name>
2214 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2215 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2216 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2217 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2218 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2219 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002220
2221 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002222 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2223 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2224 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2225 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2226 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002227
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002228 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2229 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2230 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2231 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002232
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002233 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2234
2235ssl-provider-path <path>
2236 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2237 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2238 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2239 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2240 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2241 defined.
2242 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002243
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002244ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2245 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2246 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002247 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002248 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002249 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2250
2251 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002252
2253 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2254 and won't try to remove them.
2255
2256 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2257
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002258ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002259 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002260 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2261 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2262 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002263
2264 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2265 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2266 optimize the startup time.
2267
2268 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2269 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2270 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2271
2272 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002273 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002274
2275 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002276 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2277 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002278
2279 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2280 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2281 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2282 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2283 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002284 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002285
2286 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002287 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002288 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2289 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2290 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2291 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2292 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002293 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002294
2295 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2296
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002297 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002298 a cert bundle.
2299
2300 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2301 separately in several "crt".
2302
2303 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2304 since files are loading separately.
2305
2306 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2307 required to commit them.
2308
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002309 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002310 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002311
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002312 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2313 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2314 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002315
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002316 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2317 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2318 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002319
2320 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002321 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2322 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002323
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002324 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2325 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2326
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002327 The default behavior is "all".
2328
2329 Example:
2330 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2331 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2332 ssl-load-extra-files none
2333
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002334 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2335 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002336
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002337ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2338 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2339 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2340 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2341
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002342ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002343 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002344 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2345 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2346 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2347 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2348 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2349 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002350 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002351
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002352stats maxconn <connections>
2353 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2354 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2355
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002356stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2357 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2358 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2359 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002360 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002361 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002362
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002363 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2364 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2365 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002366
2367stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2368 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2369 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002370 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002371
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002372strict-limits
2373 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2374 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2375 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2376 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2377 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002378
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002379thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2380 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2381 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2382 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2383 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2384 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2385 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2386 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2387 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2388 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2389
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002390thread-groups <number>
2391 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2392 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002393 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2394 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2395 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2396 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2397 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002398
Willy Tarreau9fd05422022-11-16 17:29:12 +01002399trace <args...>
2400 This command configures one "trace" subsystem statement. Each of them can be
2401 found in the management manual, and follow the exact same syntax. Only one
2402 statement per line is permitted (i.e. if some long trace configurations using
2403 semi-colons are to be imported, they must be placed one per line). Any output
2404 that the "trace" command would produce will be emitted during the parsing
2405 step of the section. Most of the time these will be errors and warnings, but
2406 certain incomplete commands might list permissible choices. This command is
2407 not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by developers
2408 along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally marked as
2409 experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a
2410 line before any "trace" statement. Note that these directives are parsed on
2411 the fly, so referencing a ring buffer that is only declared further will not
2412 work. For such use cases it is suggested to place another "global" section
2413 with only the "trace" statements after the declaration of that ring. It is
2414 important to keep in mind that depending on the trace level and details,
2415 enabling traces can severely degrade the global performance. Please refer to
2416 the management manual for the statements syntax.
2417
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002418uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002419 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002420 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2421 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2422 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2423
2424ulimit-n <number>
2425 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2426 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002427 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2428 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002429
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002430 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2431 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2432 manually specify this value.
2433
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002434 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2435
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002436unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2437 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2438
2439 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2440 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2441 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2442 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2443 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002444 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002445 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2446 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2447 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2448 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2449
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002450unsetenv [<name> ...]
2451 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2452 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2453 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2454 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2455 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2456 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2457 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2458
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002459user <user name>
2460 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2461 See also "uid" and "group".
2462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002463node <name>
2464 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2465
2466 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2467 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2468 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2469 traffic.
2470
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002471wurfl-cache-size <size>
2472 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2473 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2474 - "0" : no cache is used.
2475 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002476
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002477 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2478 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002479
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002480wurfl-data-file <file path>
2481 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2482 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2483
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002484 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002485 with USE_WURFL=1.
2486
2487wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2488 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2489 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2490 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2491
2492 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2493
2494 Valid WURFL properties are:
2495 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2496
2497 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2498 device.
2499
2500 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2501 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2502
2503 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2504 particular web request.
2505
2506 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2507 used Libwurfl API version.
2508
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002509 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2510 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2511
2512 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2513 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2514
2515 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2516
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002517 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002518 with USE_WURFL=1.
2519
2520wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2521 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2522 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2523
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002524 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002525 with USE_WURFL=1.
2526
2527wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2528 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2529 thus before the chroot.
2530
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002531 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002532 with USE_WURFL=1.
2533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025343.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002535-----------------------
2536
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002537busy-polling
2538 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2539 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2540 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2541 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2542 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2543 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2544 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2545 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2546 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2547 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2548 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2549 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2550 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2551 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2552 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2553 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2554 "poll" pollers.
2555
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002556 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2557 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2558 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2559
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002560max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002561 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002562 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2563 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2564 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2565 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2566 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2567 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2568 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2569
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002570maxcompcpuusage <number>
2571 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2572 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2573 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2574 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2575 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2576 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2577 and from introducing high latencies.
2578
2579maxcomprate <number>
2580 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2581 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2582 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2583 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2584 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2585 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2586 default value.
2587
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002588maxconn <number>
2589 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2590 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2591 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002592 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2593 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2594 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2595 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002596 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2597 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2598 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2599 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2600 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002601 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2602
2603 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002604
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002605maxconnrate <number>
2606 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2607 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2608 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2609 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2610 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2611 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2612 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2613 fairness.
2614
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002615maxpipes <number>
2616 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2617 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2618 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2619 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2620 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2621 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2622
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002623maxsessrate <number>
2624 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2625 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2626 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2627 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2628 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2629 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2630 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2631 fairness.
2632
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002633maxsslconn <number>
2634 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2635 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2636 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2637 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2638 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2639 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2640 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002641 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2642 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2643 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2644 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002645 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002646 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2647 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002648
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002649maxsslrate <number>
2650 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2651 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2652 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2653 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2654 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2655 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2656 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2657 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2658 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2659 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2660
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002661maxzlibmem <number>
2662 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2663 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2664 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002665 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2666 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2667 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2668
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002669no-memory-trimming
2670 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2671 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2672 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2673 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2674 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2675 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2676 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2677 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2678 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2679 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2680 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2681 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2682 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2683 not suffer from such a problem.
2684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002685noepoll
2686 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2687 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002688 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002689
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002690noevports
2691 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2692 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2693 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2694 also "nopoll".
2695
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002696nogetaddrinfo
2697 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2698 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2699
2700nokqueue
2701 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2702 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2703 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2704
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002705nopoll
2706 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2707 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002708 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002709 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2710 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002711
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002712noreuseport
2713 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2714 command line argument "-dR".
2715
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002716nosplice
2717 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002718 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002719 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002720 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002721 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2722 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2723 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2724 "option splice-response".
2725
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002726profiling.memory { on | off }
2727 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2728 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2729 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2730 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2731 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2732 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2733 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2734 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2735 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2736
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002737profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2738 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2739 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2740 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2741 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002742 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002743 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2744 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2745 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2746 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2747
2748 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2749 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2750 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2751 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2752 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002753 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2754 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2755 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2756 CLI.
2757
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002758spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002759 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2760 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2761 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2762 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2763 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2764 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002765
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002766ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002767 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002768 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002769 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002770 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002771 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2772 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2773 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002774 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2775 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002776 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2777 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2778 openssl configuration file uses:
2779 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2780
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002781ssl-mode-async
2782 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002783 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002784 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2785 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002786 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002787 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002788 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002789
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002790tune.buffers.limit <number>
2791 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2792 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2793 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2794 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2795 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002796 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002797 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2798 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2799 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2800 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2801 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2802 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2803 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2804 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002805 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002806
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002807tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2808 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2809 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2810 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002811 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002812
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002813tune.bufsize <number>
2814 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2815 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2816 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2817 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2818 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2819 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2820 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002821 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2822 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002823 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002824 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002825 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002826 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2827 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002828
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002829tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2830 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2831 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2832 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2833 this value. The default value is 1.
2834
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002835tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002836 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2837 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2838 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
2839 failures are handled gracefully.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002840
Christopher Fauletd4eaa8a2023-02-14 15:37:14 +01002841tune.fast-forward { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2842
2843 Enabled ('on') or disables ('off') the data fast-forwarding. It is a
2844 mechanism to optimize the data forwarding by passing data directly from a
2845 side to the other one without waking the stream up. Thanks to this directive,
2846 it is possible to disable this optimization. Note it also disable any kernel
2847 tcp splicing. This command is not meant for regular use, it will generally
2848 only be suggested by developers along complex debugging sessions. For this
2849 reason it is internally marked as experimental, meaning that
2850 "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a line before this directive.
2851
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002852tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2853 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2854 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2855 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2856 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2857 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2858
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002859tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2860 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2861 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2862 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2863 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2864 change it.
2865
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002866tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2867 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002868 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002869 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Glenn Strauss0012f892022-06-04 22:11:50 -04002870 The default value is 65536, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002871 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2872 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2873 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2874 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2875
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002876tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2877 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2878 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2879 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2880 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2881 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002882 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002883 recommended not to change this value.
2884
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002885tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002886 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002887 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002888 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002889 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2890 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2891 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2892 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2893
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002894tune.http.cookielen <number>
2895 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2896 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2897 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2898 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2899 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2900 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2901 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2902 to change this value.
2903
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002904tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002905 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2906 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002907 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002908 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002909 configuration directives too.
2910 The default value is 1024.
2911
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002912tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2913 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2914 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2915 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2916 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2917 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2918 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002919 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2920 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2921 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002922
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002923tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2924 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2925 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2926 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2927 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2928 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2929 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002930 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2931 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2932 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2933 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2934 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002935
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002936tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002937 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002938 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2939 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2940 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2941 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002942 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002943 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002944 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002945 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2946
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002947tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2948 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2949 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2950 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2951 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2952 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2953 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2954 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2955 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2956 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2957
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002958tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2959 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002960 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002961 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2962 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002963 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002964 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2965 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2966
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002967tune.lua.maxmem
2968 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2969 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2970 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2971 memory.
2972
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002973tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2974 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002975 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2976 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002977 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002978
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002979tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2980 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2981 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2982 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002983 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002984
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002985tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2986 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2987 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2988 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2989 check servers.
2990
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002991tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002992 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2993 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002994 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2995 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2996 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2997 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2998 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2999 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
3000 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
3001 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
3002 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003003
3004tune.maxpollevents <number>
3005 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
3006 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
3007 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
3008 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
3009 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
3010
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02003011tune.maxrewrite <number>
3012 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
3013 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
3014 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
3015 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
3016 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
3017 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
3018 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
3019 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
3020 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
3021 bufsize.
3022
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01003023tune.memory.hot-size <number>
3024 Sets the per-thread amount of memory that will be kept hot in the local cache
3025 and will never be recoverable by other threads. Access to this memory is very
3026 fast (lockless), and having enough is critical to maintain a good performance
3027 level under extreme thread contention. The value is expressed in bytes, and
3028 the default value is configured at build time via CONFIG_HAP_POOL_CACHE_SIZE
3029 which defaults to 524288 (512 kB). A larger value may increase performance in
3030 some usage scenarios, especially when performance profiles show that memory
3031 allocation is stressed a lot. Experience shows that a good value sits between
3032 once to twice the per CPU core L2 cache size. Too large values will have a
3033 negative impact on performance by making inefficient use of the L3 caches in
3034 the CPUs, and will consume larger amounts of memory. It is recommended not to
3035 change this value, or to proceed in small increments. In order to completely
3036 disable the per-thread CPU caches, using a very small value could work, but
3037 it is better to use "-dMno-cache" on the command-line.
3038
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003039tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
3040 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
3041 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
3042 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
3043 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
3044 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
3045 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
3046 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
3047 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
3048 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02003049 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
3050 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003051 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
3052 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
3053 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
3054 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
3055 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
3056 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
3057 setting this parameter to 0.
3058
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02003059tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
3060 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
3061 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
3062 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
3063 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
3064 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
3065 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
3066 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
3067
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02003068tune.pipesize <number>
3069 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
3070 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
3071 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
3072 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
3073 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
3074 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
3075
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003076tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
3077 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003078 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003079 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
3080 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
3081 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
3082 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003083 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003084
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003085tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
3086 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003087 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003088 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
3089 default is 20.
3090
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003091tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003092 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3093 change without deprecation in the future.
3094
3095 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
3096 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
3097 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
3098 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003099 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003100
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003101tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
3102 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3103 change without deprecation in the future.
3104
3105 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
3106 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
3107 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
3108 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
3109 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
3110 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
3111 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
3112
3113 The default value is 30000.
3114
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003115tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
3116 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3117 change without deprecation in the future.
3118
3119 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
3120 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
3121 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
3122 requests.
3123
3124 The default value is 100.
3125
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003126tune.quic.max-frame-loss <number>
3127 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3128 change without deprecation in the future.
3129
3130 Sets the limit for which a single QUIC frame can be marked as lost. If
3131 exceeded, the connection is considered as failing and is closed immediately.
3132
3133 The default value is 10.
3134
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003135tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
3136 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3137 change without deprecation in the future.
3138
3139 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003140 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3141 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003142 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3143 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003144 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3145 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003146
3147 The default value is 100.
3148
3149 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3150 information about QUIC retry.
3151
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003152tune.quic.socket-owner { listener | connection }
3153 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3154 change without deprecation in the future.
3155
3156 Specifies how QUIC connections will use socket for receive/send operations.
3157 Connections can share listener socket or each connection can allocate its
3158 own socket.
3159
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003160 When default "connection" value is set, a dedicated socket will be allocated
3161 by every QUIC connections. This option is the preferred one to achieve the
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003162 best performance with a large QUIC traffic. This is also the only way to
3163 ensure soft-stop is conducted properly without data loss for QUIC
3164 connections. However, this relies on some advanced features from the UDP
3165 network stack. If your platform is deemed not compatible, haproxy will
3166 automatically switch to "listener" mode on startup.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003167
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003168 The "listener" value indicates that QUIC transfers will occur on the shared
3169 listener socket. This option can be a good compromise for small traffic as it
3170 allows to reduce FD consumption. However, performance won't be optimal due to
Ilya Shipitsin5fa29b82022-12-07 09:46:19 +05003171 a higher CPU usage if listeners are shared across a lot of threads or a
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003172 large number of QUIC connections can be used simultaneously.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003173
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003174tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3175tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3176 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3177 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3178 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003179 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003180 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003181 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3182 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3183
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003184tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003185 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003186 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3187 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3188 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3189 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3190
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003191tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003192 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003193 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3194 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3195 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3196 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3197 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3198 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3199 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003200
3201tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3202 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003203 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003204 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3205 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3206 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3207 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3208 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3209 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3210 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003211
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003212tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3213tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3214 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3215 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3216 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003217 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003218 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003219 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3220 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3221 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3222 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003223 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003224
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003225tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003226 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003227 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3228 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3229 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3230 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3231 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3232 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3233 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3234 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3235 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003236 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3237 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003238
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003239tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3240tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
3241 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3242 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3243 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3244 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
3245
3246tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3247 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3248 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3249 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3250 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
3251 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3252 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3253 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3254 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3255 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3256 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3257 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3258 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
3259
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003260tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003261 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003262 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3263 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3264 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3265 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3266 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3267
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003268tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3269 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3270 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3271 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3272 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3273
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003274tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3275 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3276 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3277 performances. This is disabled by default.
3278
3279 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3280 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3281
3282 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3283
3284 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3285
3286 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3287
3288 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3289 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3290 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3291
3292 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3293 converted.
3294
3295 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3296 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3297 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3298 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3299 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3300 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3301 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003302 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3303 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003304
3305 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3306
3307 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3308 only need this line:
3309
3310 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3311
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003312tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3313 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003314 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003315 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3316 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3317 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3318 being used for too long.
3319
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003320tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003321 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3322 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3323 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3324 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3325 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3326 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3327 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3328 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3329 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3330 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3331 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3332 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3333 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003334
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003335tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3336 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3337 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3338 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3339 1000 entries.
3340
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003341tune.stick-counters <number>
3342 Sets the number of stick-counters that may be tracked at the same time by a
3343 connection or a request via "track-sc*" actions in "tcp-request" or
3344 "http-request" rules. The defaut value is set at build time by the macro
3345 MAX_SESS_STK_CTR, and defaults to 3. With this setting it is possible to
3346 change the value and ignore the one passed at build time. Increasing this
3347 value may be needed when porting complex configurations to haproxy, but users
3348 are warned against the costs: each entry takes 16 bytes per connection and
3349 16 bytes per request, all of which need to be allocated and zeroed for all
3350 requests even when not used. As such a value of 10 will inflate the memory
3351 consumption per request by 320 bytes and will cause this memory to be erased
3352 for each request, which does have measurable CPU impacts. Conversely, when
3353 no "track-sc" rules are used, the value may be lowered (0 being valid to
3354 entirely disable stick-counters).
3355
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003356tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003357tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003358tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3359tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3360tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003361 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3362 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3363 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3364 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3365 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3366 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3367 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3368 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003369
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003370 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3371 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3372 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3373 all available space is consumed.
3374 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3375 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3376 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003377
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003378tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3379 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003380 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003381 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003382 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003383 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3384
3385tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3386 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3387 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003388 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3389 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033913.3. Debugging
3392--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003393
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003394anonkey <key>
3395 This sets the global anonymizing key to <key>, which must be a 32-bit number
3396 between 0 and 4294967295. This is the key that will be used by default by CLI
3397 commands when anonymized mode is enabled. This key may also be set at runtime
Erwan Le Goasb0c05012022-09-14 17:51:55 +02003398 from the CLI command "set global-key". See also command line argument "-dC"
3399 in the management manual.
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003400
Willy Tarreaue98d3852022-11-15 09:34:07 +01003401quick-exit
3402 This speeds up the old process exit upon reload by skipping the releasing of
3403 memory objects and listeners, since all of these are reclaimed by the
3404 operating system at the process' death. The gains are only marginal (in the
3405 order of a few hundred milliseconds for huge configurations at most). The
3406 main target usage in fact is when a bug is spotted in the deinit() code, as
3407 this allows to bypass it. It is better not to use this unless instructed to
3408 do so by developers.
3409
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003410quiet
3411 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3412 line argument "-q".
3413
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003414zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003415 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003416 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3417 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3418 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3419 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3420 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3421
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010034233.4. Userlists
3424--------------
3425It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3426http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3427it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3428
3429userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003430 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003431 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3432
3433group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003434 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003435 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3436 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3437
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003438user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3439 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003440 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3441 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003442 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3443 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3444 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3445 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003446
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003447 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3448 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3449 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3450 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3451 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3452 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3453 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003454 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003455 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003456
3457 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003458 userlist L1
3459 group G1 users tiger,scott
3460 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003461
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003462 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3463 user scott insecure-password elgato
3464 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003465
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003466 userlist L2
3467 group G1
3468 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003469
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003470 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3471 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3472 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003473
3474 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003475
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003476
34773.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003478----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003479It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003480several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003481instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003482values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3483type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3484values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3485active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3486switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3487present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3488watch it.
3489
3490Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3491known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3492the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3493process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3494during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3495tables.
3496
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003497Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3498that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3499each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003500
3501peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003502 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003503 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3504
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003505bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3506 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3507 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3508
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003509disabled
3510 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3511 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3512 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3513
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003514default-bind [param*]
3515 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3516
3517default-server [param*]
3518 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3519
3520 Arguments:
3521 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3522 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003523 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3524 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3525 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3526 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003527
3528 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3529
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003530enabled
3531 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3532 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003533
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003534log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003535 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3536 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3537 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3538 more details.
3539
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003540peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003541 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3542 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003543 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003544 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003545 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3546 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3547 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003548
3549 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3550 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3551
3552 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003553 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3554 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3555 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003556
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003557 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3558 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003559
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003560 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3561 "server" keyword explanation below).
3562
3563server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003564 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003565 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3566 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3567 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3568 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003569
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003570 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3571 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3572 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3573 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3574 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003575
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003576 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003577 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003578 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003579 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3580 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3581 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003582
3583 backend mybackend
3584 mode tcp
3585 balance roundrobin
3586 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3587 stick on src
3588
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003589 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3590 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003591
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003592 Example:
3593 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003594 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3595 default-server ssl verify none
3596 server haproxy1 #local peer
3597 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3598 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003599
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +02003600shards <shards>
3601
3602 In some configurations, one would like to distribute the stick-table contents
3603 to some peers in place of sending all the stick-table contents to each peer
3604 declared in the "peers" section. In such cases, "shards" specifies the
3605 number of peer involved in this stick-table contents distribution.
3606 See also "shard" server parameter.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003607
3608table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3609 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3610
3611 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3612 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003613 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003614 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3615 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3616 "stick-table" keyword).
3617
3618 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3619 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3620 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3621 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3622 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3623 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3624 of the stick-table name as follows:
3625
3626 peers mypeers
3627 peer A ...
3628 peer B ...
3629 table t1 ...
3630
3631 frontend fe1
3632 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3633
3634 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3635 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3636
3637 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3638 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3639 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3640 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3641 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3642 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3643 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3644
3645 peers mypeers
3646 peer A ...
3647 peer B ...
3648 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3649
3650 backend t1
3651 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3652
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003653 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003654 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3655 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3656
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090036573.6. Mailers
3658------------
3659It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3660If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3661in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3662
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003663mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003664 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3665 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3666
3667mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3668 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3669
3670 Example:
3671 mailers mymailers
3672 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3673 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3674
3675 backend mybackend
3676 mode tcp
3677 balance roundrobin
3678
3679 email-alert mailers mymailers
3680 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3681 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3682
3683 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3684 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3685
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003686timeout mail <time>
3687 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3688 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3689 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3690 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3691
3692 Example:
3693 mailers mymailers
3694 timeout mail 20s
3695 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003696
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020036973.7. Programs
3698-------------
3699In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3700master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3701managed the same way as the workers.
3702
3703During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3704sequence as a worker:
3705
3706 - the master is re-executed
3707 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3708 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3709 instance of the program
3710
3711During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3712
3713program <name>
3714 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3715 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3716 the management guide).
3717
3718command <command> [arguments*]
3719 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3720 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3721 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3722 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3723
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003724user <user name>
3725 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3726 See also "group".
3727
3728group <group name>
3729 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3730 See also "user".
3731
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003732option start-on-reload
3733no option start-on-reload
3734 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3735 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3736 program section.
3737
3738
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010037393.8. HTTP-errors
3740----------------
3741
3742It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3743imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3744several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3745
3746http-errors <name>
3747 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3748 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3749
3750errorfile <code> <file>
3751 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3752
3753 Arguments :
3754 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003755 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003756 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003757
3758 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3759 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3760 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3761 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3762 before any chroot is performed.
3763
3764 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3765
3766 Example:
3767 http-errors website-1
3768 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3769 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3770 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3771
3772 http-errors website-2
3773 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3774 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3775 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3776
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020037773.9. Rings
3778----------
3779
3780It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3781servers or traces.
3782
3783ring <ringname>
3784 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3785
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003786backing-file <path>
3787 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
3788 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
3789 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
3790 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
3791 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
3792 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
3793 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
3794
3795 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
3796 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
3797 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
3798 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreau32872db2022-08-31 18:52:17 +02003799 by the "size" directive. When the directive is parsed (thus even during
3800 config checks), any existing non-empty file will first be renamed with the
3801 extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak" will
3802 be removed. This ensures that instant reload or restart of the process will
3803 not wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to
3804 spot this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. As such, after a crash
3805 the file designated by <path> will contain the freshest information, and if
3806 the service is restarted, the "<path>.bak" file will have it instead. This
3807 means that the total storage capacity required will be double of the ring
3808 size. Failures to rotate the file are silently ignored, so placing the file
3809 into a directory without write permissions will be sufficient to avoid the
3810 backup file if not desired.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003811
3812 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
3813 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
3814 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
3815 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
3816 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
3817 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
3818 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
3819
3820 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
3821 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
3822 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
3823
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003824description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003825 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003826 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3827
3828format <format>
3829 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3830
3831 Arguments:
3832 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3833 one of the following :
3834
3835 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3836 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3837 designed to be used with a local log server.
3838
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003839 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3840 field is stripped. This is the default.
3841 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3842 rfc3164.
3843
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003844 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3845 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3846 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3847 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3848 is the default.
3849
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003850 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003851 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3852
3853 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3854 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3855
3856 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3857 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3858 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3859 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3860 logger consumes.
3861
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003862 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3863 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3864 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3865 with a local log server.
3866
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003867 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3868 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3869 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3870 used with a local log server.
3871
3872maxlen <length>
3873 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3874 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3875 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3876
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003877server <name> <address> [param*]
3878 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3879 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3880 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3881 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3882 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3883 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3884 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3885 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3886 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003887 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3888 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003889
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003890size <size>
3891 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3892 set to BUFSIZE.
3893
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003894timeout connect <timeout>
3895 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3896
3897 Arguments :
3898 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3899 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3900 as explained at the top of this document.
3901
3902timeout server <timeout>
3903 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3904
3905 Arguments :
3906 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3907 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3908 as explained at the top of this document.
3909
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003910 Example:
3911 global
3912 log ring@myring local7
3913
3914 ring myring
3915 description "My local buffer"
3916 format rfc3164
3917 maxlen 1200
3918 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003919 timeout connect 5s
3920 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003921 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003922
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020039233.10. Log forwarding
3924-------------------
3925
3926It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003927HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003928
3929log-forward <name>
3930 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3931
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003932backlog <conns>
3933 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3934 on connections accept.
3935
3936bind <addr> [param*]
3937 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003938 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3939 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3940 syslog protocol over TCP.
3941 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003942 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3943
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003944dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003945 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3946 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3947 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3948 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003949 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003950
3951log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003952log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003953 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3954 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3955 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003956 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003957 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3958 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3959 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003960 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003961
3962 Example:
3963 global
3964 log stderr format iso local7
3965
3966 ring myring
3967 description "My local buffer"
3968 format rfc5424
3969 maxlen 1200
3970 size 32764
3971 timeout connect 5s
3972 timeout server 10s
3973 # syslog tcp server
3974 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3975
3976 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003977 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3978 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003979 # all messages on stderr
3980 log global
3981 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3982 log ring@myring local0
3983 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3984 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3985 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3986 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3987 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003988
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003989maxconn <conns>
3990 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3991 10 is the default.
3992
3993timeout client <timeout>
3994 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020039964. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003997----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003998
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003999Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004000 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
4001 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4002 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4003 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004004
4005A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
4006connections.
4007
4008A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
4009to forward incoming connections.
4010
4011A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
4012parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
4013
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004014A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
4015ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
4016sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
4017the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
4018explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
4019from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
4020"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
4021for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
4022to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
4023optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
4024are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
4025any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
4026names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
4027that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
4028duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02004029names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
4030is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
4031implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
4032encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
4033adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004034
4035Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
4036settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
4037of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
4038profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
4039timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
4040
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004041All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
4042'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
4043case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
4044
4045Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
4046logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
4047proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
4048However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
4049name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
4050
4051Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
4052and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004053bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004054protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
4055modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
4056arbitrary criteria.
4057
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004058In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
4059a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01004060the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004061
4062 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
4063 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
4064 between responses and new requests.
4065
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004066 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
4067 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
4068 client-facing connection remains open.
4069
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004070 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
4071 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004072
4073The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
4074frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
4075following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004076weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004077
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004078 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004079
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004080 | KAL | SCL | CLO
4081 ----+-----+-----+----
4082 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
4083 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004084 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
4085 ----+-----+-----+----
4086 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004087
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004088It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004089only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
4090within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004091as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004092content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004093and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
4094possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004095
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004096There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004097first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004098processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004099second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004100protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
4101is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
4102new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004103to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004104process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
4105already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
4106HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
4107evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
4108one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
4109
4110There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
4111performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
4112tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
4113preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
4114analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
4115HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
4116header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
4117mitigate this drawback.
4118
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004119There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004120method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
4121set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
4122in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
4123is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
4124to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
4125above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
4126to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
4127"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
4128frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
4129frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
4130as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
4131upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
4132on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
4133the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
4134upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
4135frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
4136remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020041384.1. Proxy keywords matrix
4139--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004141The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
4142limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
4143they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
4144limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004145marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004146option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02004147and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
4148with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004149specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
4150sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
4151anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004152
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004153
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004154 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
4155------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004156acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004157backlog X X X -
4158balance X - X X
4159bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004160capture cookie - X X -
4161capture request header - X X -
4162capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004163clitcpka-cnt X X X -
4164clitcpka-idle X X X -
4165clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004166compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004167cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004168declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004169default-server X - X X
4170default_backend X X X -
4171description - X X X
4172disabled X X X X
4173dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004174email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004175email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004176email-alert mailers X X X X
4177email-alert myhostname X X X X
4178email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004179enabled X X X X
4180errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004181errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004182errorloc X X X X
4183errorloc302 X X X X
4184-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4185errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004186error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004187force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004188filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004189fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004190hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004191http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004192http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004193http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004194http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004195http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02004196http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02004197http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004198http-check set-var X - X X
4199http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004200http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004201http-request X (!) X X X
4202http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004203http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONdf238c32023-01-12 15:59:27 +01004204http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004205id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004206ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004207load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004208log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004209log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004210log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004211log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004212max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004213maxconn X X X -
4214mode X X X X
4215monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004216monitor-uri X X X -
4217option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4218option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4219option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4220option allbackups (*) X - X X
4221option checkcache (*) X - X X
4222option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4223option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004224option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004225option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4226option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004227-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4228option forwardfor X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01004229option forwarded (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004230option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4231option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004232option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004233option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004234option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004235option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004236option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004237option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004238option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4239option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4240option httpchk X - X X
4241option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004242option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004243option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004244option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004245option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004246option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004247option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4248option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4249option logasap (*) X X X -
4250option mysql-check X - X X
4251option nolinger (*) X X X X
4252option originalto X X X X
4253option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004254option pgsql-check X - X X
4255option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004256option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004257option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004258option smtpchk X - X X
4259option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4260option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4261option splice-request (*) X X X X
4262option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +01004263option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004264option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4265option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4266-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004267option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004268option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4269option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4270option tcpka X X X X
4271option tcplog X X X X
4272option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004273option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004274external-check command X - X X
4275external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004276persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4277rate-limit sessions X X X -
4278redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004279-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004280retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004281retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004282server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004283server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004284server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004285source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004286srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4287srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4288srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004289stats admin - X X X
4290stats auth X X X X
4291stats enable X X X X
4292stats hide-version X X X X
4293stats http-request - X X X
4294stats realm X X X X
4295stats refresh X X X X
4296stats scope X X X X
4297stats show-desc X X X X
4298stats show-legends X X X X
4299stats show-node X X X X
4300stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004301-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4302stick match - - X X
4303stick on - - X X
4304stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004305stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004306stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004307tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004308tcp-check connect X - X X
4309tcp-check expect X - X X
4310tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004311tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004312tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004313tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004314tcp-check set-var X - X X
4315tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004316tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4317tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4318tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4319tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4320tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4321tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004322timeout check X - X X
4323timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004324timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004325timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004326timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4327timeout http-request X X X X
4328timeout queue X - X X
4329timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004330timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004331timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004332timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004333transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004334unique-id-format X X X -
4335unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004336use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004337use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004338use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004339------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4340 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020043434.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4344---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004345
4346This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4347
4348
4349acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4350 Declare or complete an access list.
4351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004352 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4353
4354 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4355 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4356 using it.
4357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004358 Example:
4359 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4360 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4361 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004363 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004364
4365
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004366backlog <conns>
4367 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4369 yes | yes | yes | no
4370 Arguments :
4371 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4372 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004373 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004374
4375 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4376 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4377 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4378 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4379 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4380 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4381 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4382 backlog parameter.
4383
4384 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4385 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4386 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4387
4388 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4389
4390
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004391balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004392balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004393 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4395 yes | no | yes | yes
4396 Arguments :
4397 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4398 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4399 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4400 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4401
4402 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4403 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4404 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4405 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004406 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004407 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004408 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4409 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4410 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4411 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4412 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4413 it, so that you don't worry.
4414
4415 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4416 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4417 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4418 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4419 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4420 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4421 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4422 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004423
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004424 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4425 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4426 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4427 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4428 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4429 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4430 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004431 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4432 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4433 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004434
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004435 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004436 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004437 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4438 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004439 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004440 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4441 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4442 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4443 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4444 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004445 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4446 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4447 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4448 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4449 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4450 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004451
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004452 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4453 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4454 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4455 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4456 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4457 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4458 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4459 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4460 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4461 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4462 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4463 changed using "hash-type".
4464
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004465 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4466 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4467 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4468 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4469 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4470 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4471 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4472 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004473 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004474 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004475 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4476 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004477 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004478
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004479 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4480 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4481 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4482 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4483 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4484 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4485 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4486 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4487 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4488 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4489 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4490 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004491
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004492 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004493 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4494 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4495 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4496 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4497 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4498 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4499 URIs start with a leading "/".
4500
4501 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4502 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4503 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4504 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4505
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004506 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4507 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4508 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004509 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4510 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004511
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004512 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004513 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4514
4515 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004516 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4517 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004518 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4519 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4520 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4521 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004522 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004523 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4524 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004525
4526 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4527 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4528 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4529 server will receive the request.
4530
4531 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4532 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4533 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4534 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4535 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004536 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4537 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004538 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4539 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004540
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004541 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4542 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4543 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4544 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4545 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004546
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004547 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004548 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4549 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4550 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4551
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004552 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4553 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004554 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4555 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004556
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004557 random
4558 random(<draws>)
4559 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004560 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4561 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4562 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4563 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004564 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4565 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4566 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4567 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4568 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4569 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4570 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4571 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4572 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4573 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4574 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4575 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4576 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4577 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4578 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4579 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4580 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4581 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4582 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4583 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004584
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004585 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004586 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004587 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4588 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004589 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004590 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4591 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4592 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004593 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004594 used instead.
4595
4596 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4597 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4598 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004599 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004600
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004601 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4602 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004603 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4604 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004606 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004607 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4608 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004609
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004610 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4611 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4612 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004613
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004614 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004615 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004616 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4617 NTLM relies on.
4618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004619 Examples :
4620 balance roundrobin
4621 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004622 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004623 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4624 balance hdr(host)
4625 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004626 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4627 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4628 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004629
4630 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4631 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004633 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004634 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4635 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4636 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004637 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004638
4639 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4640 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4641 defaults to 16 kB.
4642
4643 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4644 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4645
4646 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4647 Round Robin.
4648
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004649 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004650 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4651 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4652 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4653
4654 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4655
4656 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004657 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004658 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4659 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4660 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004661
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004662 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004663
4664
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004665bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4666bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004667 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4669 no | yes | yes | no
4670 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004671 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4672 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4673 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4674 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004675 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
4676 that if you bind a frontend to multiple UDP addresses you have
4677 no guarantee about the address which will be used to respond.
4678 This is why "0.0.0.0" addresses and lists of comma-separated
4679 IP addresses have been forbidden to bind QUIC addresses.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004680 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4681 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4682 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4683 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4684 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4685 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004686 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004687 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4688 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004689 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004690 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4691 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004692 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004693 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4694 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004695 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004696 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004697 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4698 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4699 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004700 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4701 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4702 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4703 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004704 - 'quic4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01004705 is used. Note that to achieve the best performance with a
4706 large traffic you should keep "tune.quic.conn-owner" on
4707 connection. Else QUIC connections will be multiplexed
4708 over the listener socket. Another alternative would be to
4709 duplicate QUIC listener instances over several threads,
4710 for example using "shards" keyword to at least reduce
4711 thread contention.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004712 - 'quic6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyelle7078fb12022-11-22 11:26:16 +01004713 is used. The performance note for QUIC over IPv4 applies
4714 as well.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004715
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004716 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4717 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4718 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004719
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004720 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4721 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004722 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4723 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4724 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004725 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4726 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4727 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4728 the range.
4729
4730 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4731 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4732 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4733 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4734 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4735 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4736 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004737 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004738 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004739
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004740 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004741 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004742 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4743 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4744 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4745 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4746 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4747 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4748
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004749 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4750 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4751 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4752 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004753
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004754 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4755 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4756 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4757 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4758 in a frontend.
4759
4760 Example :
4761 listen http_proxy
4762 bind :80,:443
4763 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004764 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004765
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004766 listen http_https_proxy
4767 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004768 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004769
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004770 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4771 bind ipv6@:80
4772 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4773 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4774
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004775 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004776 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004777
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004778 listen h3_quic_proxy
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004779 bind quic4@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt alpn h3
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004780
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004781 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4782 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4783 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4784 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4785 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4786
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004787 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004788 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004789
4790
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004791capture cookie <name> len <length>
4792 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4794 no | yes | yes | no
4795 Arguments :
4796 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4797 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4798 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4799 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004800 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004801
4802 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4803 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4804 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4805 right if it exceeds <length>.
4806
4807 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4808 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4809 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4810 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4811
4812 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4813 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4814 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4815
4816 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4817 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4818 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004819 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4820 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4821 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004822
4823 Example:
4824 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4825
4826 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004827 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004828
4829
4830capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004831 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4833 no | yes | yes | no
4834 Arguments :
4835 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004836 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004837 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4838 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4839 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4840
4841 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4842 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4843 it exceeds <length>.
4844
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004845 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004846 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4847 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004848 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4849 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4850 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4851 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004852 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004853 environments to find where the request came from.
4854
4855 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4856 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4857 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4858 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004859
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004860 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4861 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4862 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4863 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4864 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004865
4866 Example:
4867 capture request header Host len 15
4868 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004869 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004871 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004872 about logging.
4873
4874
4875capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004876 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4878 no | yes | yes | no
4879 Arguments :
4880 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004881 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004882 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4883 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4884 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4885
4886 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4887 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4888 it exceeds <length>.
4889
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004890 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004891 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4892 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4893 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004894 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4895 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4896 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4897 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004898
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004899 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4900 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4901 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4902 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4903 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004904
4905 Example:
4906 capture response header Content-length len 9
4907 capture response header Location len 15
4908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004909 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004910 about logging.
4911
4912
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004913clitcpka-cnt <count>
4914 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4915 the connection on the client side.
4916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4917 yes | yes | yes | no
4918 Arguments :
4919 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4920
4921 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4922 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004923 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4924 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004925
4926 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4927
4928
4929clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4930 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4931 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4932 client side.
4933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | yes | yes | no
4935 Arguments :
4936 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4937 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4938 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4939 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4940
4941 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4942 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004943 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4944 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004945
4946 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4947
4948
4949clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4950 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4952 yes | yes | yes | no
4953 Arguments :
4954 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4955 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4956 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4957 document.
4958
4959 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4960 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004961 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4962 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004963
4964 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4965
4966
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004967compression algo <algorithm> ...
4968compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004969 Enable HTTP compression.
4970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4971 yes | yes | yes | yes
4972 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004973 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4974 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004975
4976 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004977 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4978 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4979 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004980
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004981 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004982 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004983
4984 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4985 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4986 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4987 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4988 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004989 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004990
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004991 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4992 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4993 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4994 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4995 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4996 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4997 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004998 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004999
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04005000 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005001 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005002 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005003 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005004 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005005 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005006 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02005007
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005008 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005009 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
5010 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02005011 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005012 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005013 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
5014 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
5015 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
5016 "multipart"
5017 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
5018 header
5019 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
5020 and later
5021 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
5022 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005023 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005024
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01005025 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005026
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005027 Examples :
5028 compression algo gzip
5029 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005030
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01005031 See also : "compression offload"
5032
5033compression offload
5034 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
5035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5036 no | yes | yes | yes
5037
5038 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
5039 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
5040 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
5041 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
5042 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
5043 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
5044 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
5045 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
5046 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
5047 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
5048 then be used for such scenarios.
5049
5050 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
5051 option is ignored.
5052
5053 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005054
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005055cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005056 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
5057 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005058 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005059 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
5060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5061 yes | no | yes | yes
5062 Arguments :
5063 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
5064 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
5065 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
5066 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
5067 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
5068 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005069 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005070 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
5071 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
5072
5073 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005074 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005075 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
5076 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
5077 headers is left to the application. The application can then
5078 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005079 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
5080 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005081 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005082 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
5083 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005084
5085 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005086 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005087
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005088 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005089 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005090 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005091 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005092 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
5093 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
5094 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
5095 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
5096 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
5097 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
5098 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005099
5100 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
5101 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
5102 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
5103 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
5104 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
5105 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
5106 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
5107 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
5108 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005109 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005110 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
5111 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
5112 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005113
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005114 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
5115 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
5116 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005117 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
5118 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
5119 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
5120 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005121 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
5122 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
5123 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005124
5125 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
5126 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
5127 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
5128 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
5129 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
5130 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
5131 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
5132 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
5133 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
5134
5135 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
5136 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
5137 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
5138 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
5139 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
5140 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
5141 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
5142 persistence cookie in the cache.
5143 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
5144
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005145 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
5146 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005147 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005148 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
5149 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005150 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005151 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
5152 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
5153 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
5154 they logout.
5155
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005156 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005157 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
5158 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
5159 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
5160
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005161 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005162 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
5163 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
5164 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
5165 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
5166 this attribute.
5167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005168 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005169 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01005170 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
5171 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
5172 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
5173 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
5174 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
5175 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005176
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005177 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
5178 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
5179 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
5180 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
5181 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
5182 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
5183 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
5184 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005185 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005186 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
5187 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
5188 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
5189 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
5190 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
5191 the site.
5192
5193 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
5194 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
5195 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
5196 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
5197 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
5198 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
5199 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
5200 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
5201 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
5202 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
5203 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
5204 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
5205 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005206 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005207 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5208 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5209
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005210 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5211 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5212 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5213 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5214 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5215 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5216
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005217 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005218 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5219 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5220 repeated.
5221
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005222 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5223 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5224 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5225 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005226
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005227 Examples :
5228 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5229 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5230 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005231 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005232
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005233 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005234
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005235
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005236declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5237 Declares a capture slot.
5238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5239 no | yes | yes | no
5240 Arguments:
5241 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5242
5243 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5244 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5245 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5246 for use in the response.
5247
5248 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005249 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005250 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5251
5252
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005253default-server [param*]
5254 Change default options for a server in a backend
5255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5256 yes | no | yes | yes
5257 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005258 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5259 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5260 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5261 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005262
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005263 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005264 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5265
5266 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005267
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005268
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005269default_backend <backend>
5270 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5272 yes | yes | yes | no
5273 Arguments :
5274 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5275
5276 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5277 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5278 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5279 will catch all undetermined requests.
5280
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005281 Example :
5282
5283 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5284 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5285 default_backend dynamic
5286
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005287 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005288
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005289
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005290description <string>
5291 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5293 no | yes | yes | yes
5294 Arguments : string
5295
5296 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5297 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5298 it describes.
5299 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5300
5301
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005302disabled
5303 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5305 yes | yes | yes | yes
5306 Arguments : none
5307
5308 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5309 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5310 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5311 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5312 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5313 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5314 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5315
5316 See also : "enabled"
5317
5318
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005319dispatch <address>:<port>
5320 Set a default server address
5321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5322 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005323 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005324
5325 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5326 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5327 during start-up.
5328
5329 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5330 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5331 possible with normal servers.
5332
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005333 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005334 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5335 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5336 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5337 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5338
5339 See also : "server"
5340
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005341
5342dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5343 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5345 yes | no | yes | yes
5346 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5347
5348 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005349 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005350 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5351 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005352 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005353 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005355enabled
5356 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5358 yes | yes | yes | yes
5359 Arguments : none
5360
5361 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5362 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5363
5364 See also : "disabled"
5365
5366
5367errorfile <code> <file>
5368 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5370 yes | yes | yes | yes
5371 Arguments :
5372 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005373 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005374 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005375
5376 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005377 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005378 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005379 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5380 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005381
5382 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5383 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5384 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5385
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005386 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5387
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005388 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5389 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5390 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5391 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5392 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5393 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5394 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5395 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5396 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005397
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005398 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5399 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5400 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005401 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005402 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5403
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005404 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005405
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005406 Example :
5407 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005408 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005409 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5410 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5411
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005412
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005413errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5414 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5415 section.
5416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5417 yes | yes | yes | yes
5418 Arguments :
5419 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5420
5421 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005422 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005423 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5424 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005425
5426 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5427 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5428 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5429 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5430 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005431 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005432 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5433
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005434 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5435 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005436
5437 Example :
5438 errorfiles generic
5439 errorfiles site-1 403 404
5440
5441
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005442errorloc <code> <url>
5443errorloc302 <code> <url>
5444 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5446 yes | yes | yes | yes
5447 Arguments :
5448 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005449 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005450 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005451
5452 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5453 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5454 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5455 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005456 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005457
5458 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5459 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5460 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5461
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005462 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5463
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005464 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5465 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5466 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5467 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005468 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005469 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5470 request.
5471
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005472 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005473
5474
5475errorloc303 <code> <url>
5476 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5478 yes | yes | yes | yes
5479 Arguments :
5480 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005481 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005482 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005483
5484 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5485 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5486 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5487 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005488 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005489
5490 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5491 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5492 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5493
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005494 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5495
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005496 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5497 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5498 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5499 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005500 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005501
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005502 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005503
5504
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005505email-alert from <emailaddr>
5506 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005507 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005508 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5509 yes | yes | yes | yes
5510
5511 Arguments :
5512
5513 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5514
5515 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5516 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5517
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005518 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005519 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5520 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005521
5522
5523email-alert level <level>
5524 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5525 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5526 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5527 yes | yes | yes | yes
5528
5529 Arguments :
5530
5531 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5532 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5533 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5534
5535 By default level is alert
5536
5537 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5538 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5539 for the proxy.
5540
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005541 Alerts are sent when :
5542
5543 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5544 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5545 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5546 is notice or lower
5547 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5548 and a health check status update occurs
5549
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005550 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5551 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005552 section 3.6 about mailers.
5553
5554
5555email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5556 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5557 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5558 yes | yes | yes | yes
5559
5560 Arguments :
5561
5562 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5563
5564 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5565 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5566
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005567 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5568 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005569
5570
5571email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5572 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5573 mailers.
5574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5575 yes | yes | yes | yes
5576
5577 Arguments :
5578
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005579 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005580
5581 By default the systems hostname is used.
5582
5583 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5584 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5585 for the proxy.
5586
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005587 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5588 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005589
5590
5591email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005592 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005593 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5594 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5595 yes | yes | yes | yes
5596
5597 Arguments :
5598
5599 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5600
5601 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5602 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5603
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005604 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005605 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5606
5607
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005608error-log-format <string>
5609 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5610 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5611 yes | yes | yes | no
5612
5613 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5614 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5615 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5616 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005617 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5618
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005619 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5620 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5621 string in depth.
5622
5623 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5624 directives.
5625
5626
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005627force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5628 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5629 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005630 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005631
5632 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5633 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5634 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5635 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5636 marked down for maintenance operations.
5637
5638 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5639 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5640 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5641 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5642 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5643 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5644 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5645 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5646 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5647
5648 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5649 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5650 is used.
5651
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005652 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005653 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005654
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005655
5656filter <name> [param*]
5657 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5659 no | yes | yes | yes
5660 Arguments :
5661 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5662 referenced in section 9.
5663
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005664 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005665 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005666 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5667 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005668
5669 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5670 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5671
5672 Example:
5673 listen
5674 bind *:80
5675
5676 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5677 filter compression
5678 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5679
5680 compression algo gzip
5681 compression offload
5682
5683 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5684
5685 See also : section 9.
5686
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005687
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005688fullconn <conns>
5689 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5691 yes | no | yes | yes
5692 Arguments :
5693 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5694 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5695
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005696 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005697 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005698 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005699 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5700 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5701 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5702 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5703 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005704 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005705
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005706 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005707 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005708 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5709 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5710 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005711
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005712 Example :
5713 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5714 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5715 # connections.
5716 backend dynamic
5717 fullconn 10000
5718 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5719 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5720
5721 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5722
5723
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005724hash-balance-factor <factor>
5725 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5727 yes | no | no | yes
5728 Arguments :
5729 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5730 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005731 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005732
5733 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5734 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5735 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5736 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5737 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5738 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5739 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5740
5741 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5742 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5743 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5744 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5745 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5746
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005747 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5748 consistent hashing mechanism.
5749
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005750 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5751
5752
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005753hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005754 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5756 yes | no | yes | yes
5757 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005758 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5759 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005760
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005761 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5762 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5763 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5764 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5765 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5766 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5767 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5768 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5769 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5770 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005771
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005772 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5773 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5774 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5775 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5776 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5777 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5778 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5779 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5780 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5781 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5782 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5783 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5784 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005785 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5786 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005787
5788 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5789
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005790 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005791 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5792 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5793 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005794 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5795 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5796 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005797
5798 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5799 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005800 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5801 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5802 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5803 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5804
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005805 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005806 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5807 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5808 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5809 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5810 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5811 parameter.
5812
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005813 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5814 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5815 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5816 used on strings.
5817
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005818 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5819
5820 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5821 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5822 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5823 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5824 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5825 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5826 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5827 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5828 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5829 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5830 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5831 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005832
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005833 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5834 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5835 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005836
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005837 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005838
5839
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005840http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5841 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5842 ones).
5843
5844 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005845 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005846
5847 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5848 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5849 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5850 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5851 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5852 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5853
5854 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5855 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5856 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5857
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005858 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5859 supported:
5860 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5861 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005862 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005863 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005864 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005865 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005866 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5867 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005868 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
5869 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
5870 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
5871 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5872 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005873 - set-header <name> <fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005874 - set-log-level <level>
5875 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005876 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005877 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5878 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005879 - strict-mode { on | off }
5880 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5881
5882 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005883
5884 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5885 instance.
5886
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005887 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5888 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5889 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5890 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5891 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5892 a defaults section defining such rules.
5893
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005894 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5895 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5896 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5897
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005898 Example:
5899 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5900 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5901 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5902
5903http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5904
5905 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005906 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5907 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005908
Christopher Fauletd9d36b82023-01-05 10:25:30 +01005909http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5910
5911 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5912 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
5913
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005914http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5915
5916 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5917 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5918 complete description.
5919
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005920http-after-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5921
5922 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
5923 del-acl" for a complete description.
5924
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005925http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005926
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005927 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5928 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005929
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005930http-after-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5931
5932 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
5933 del-map" for a complete description.
5934
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005935http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5936 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5937
5938 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5939
5940 Example:
5941 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5942
5943 # applied to:
5944 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5945
5946 # outputs:
5947 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5948
5949 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5950
5951http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5952 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5953
5954 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5955
5956 Example:
5957 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5958
5959 # applied to:
5960 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5961
5962 # outputs:
5963 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5964
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005965http-after-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5966http-after-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5967http-after-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5968
5969 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
5970 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
5971 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
5972 description.
5973
5974http-after-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5975 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5976http-after-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5977 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5978
5979 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
5980 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
5981 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
5982
5983http-after-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5984
5985 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
5986 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
5987
5988http-after-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5989
5990 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
5991 set-map" for a complete description.
5992
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005993http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5994
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005995 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
5996 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5997 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5998 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005999
6000http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6001 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6002
6003 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05006004 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006005 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006006
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006007http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6008http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006009
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006010 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6011 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
6012 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006013
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006014http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006015
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006016 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
6017 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006018
6019http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6020
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006021 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
6022 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006023
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006024
6025http-check comment <string>
6026 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
6027 it fails.
6028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6029 yes | no | yes | yes
6030
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006031 Arguments :
6032 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
6033 rule fails.
6034
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006035 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
6036 user-friendly error reporting.
6037
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006038 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006039 "http-check expect".
6040
6041
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006042http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
6043 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006044 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006045 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
6046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6047 yes | no | yes | yes
6048
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006049 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006050 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6051
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006052 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006053 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006054
6055 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
6056 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6057 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
6058 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
6059
6060 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
6061
6062 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6063
6064 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
6065
6066 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6067
6068 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
6069
6070 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
6071 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
6072 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
6073 is used.
6074
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006075 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
6076 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
6077 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
6078 haproxy -vv.
6079
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006080 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
6081
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006082 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
6083 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
6084 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
6085 different ports or with different servers.
6086
6087 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6088 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
6089 the port with a "http-check connect".
6090
6091 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6092 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6093 do.
6094
6095 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
6096 unset-var or comment rules.
6097
6098 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006099 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6100 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6101 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6102 option httpchk
6103
6104 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006105 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006106 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006107 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006108 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006109 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006110
6111 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6112
6113 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006114
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006116http-check disable-on-404
6117 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
6118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006119 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006120 Arguments : none
6121
6122 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
6123 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
6124 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
6125 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
6126 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
6127 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
6128 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
6129 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006130 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
6131 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01006132 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
6133 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
6134 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006135
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006136 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006137
6138
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006139http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006140 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
6141 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
6142 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006143 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02006145 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006146
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006147 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006148 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6149
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006150 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
6151 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
6152 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
6153 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
6154 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
6155 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
6156 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
6157 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
6158 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
6159 result is always conclusive.
6160
6161 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6162 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
6163 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006164 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
6165 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006166 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6167 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006168 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
6169 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
6170 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006171
6172 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6173 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006174 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
6175 supported :
6176 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6177 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006178 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
6179 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
6180 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
6181 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
6182 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006183
6184 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6185 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006186 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
6187 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
6188 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
6189 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006190 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
6191
6192 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6193 informational message reported in logs if the expect
6194 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
6195 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
6196
6197 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6198 informational message reported in logs if an error
6199 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
6200 log-format string.
6201
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006202 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006203 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
6204 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006205 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
6206 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
6207 details on the supported keywords.
6208
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006209 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
6210 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
6211 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
6212 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006213
6214 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
6215 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
6216 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
6217 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
6218 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
6219
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006220 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
6221 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
6222 codes. A health check response will be considered as
6223 valid if the response's status code matches any status
6224 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
6225 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6226 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006227
6228 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006229 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006230 response's status code matches the expression. If the
6231 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6232 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
6233 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
6234
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006235 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6236 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006237 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
6238 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
6239 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
6240 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
6241 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
6242 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
6243 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
6244 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006245 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
6246 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
6247 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
6248 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
6249 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
6250 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
6251 insensitive on the header names.
6252
6253 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6254 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6255 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6256 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6257 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6258 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006259
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006260 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006261 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006262 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6263 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6264 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6265 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6266 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006267 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006268 trace).
6269
6270 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006271 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006272 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6273 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6274 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6275 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6276 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006277 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006278
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006279 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6280 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6281 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6282 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6283 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6284 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6285
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006286 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006287 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006288 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6289 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6290 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6291 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6292 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6293 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6294
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006295 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6296 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6297 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6298 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6299 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006300
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006301 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6302 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6303
6304 Examples :
6305 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006306 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006307
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006308 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6309 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006311 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006312 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006313
6314 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006315 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006316
6317 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006318 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006319
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006320 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006321 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006322
6323
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006324http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006325 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6326 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006327 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6328 health checks.
6329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6330 yes | no | yes | yes
6331 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006332 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6333
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006334 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6335 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6336 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6337 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6338 to invent non-standard ones.
6339
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006340 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6341 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6342 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6343 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6344
6345 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6346 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6347 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6348 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006349
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006350 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006351 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006352 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006353 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6354 to add it.
6355
6356 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6357 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6358 to the log-format rules.
6359
6360 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6361 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6362 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006363
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006364 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6365 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6366 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6367 request.
6368
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006369 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6370 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6371 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006372 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6373 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6374 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6375 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006376 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006377
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006378 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006379 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6380 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006381
6382 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6383 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6384 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6385 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6386 configured request authority.
6387
6388 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6389 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006390
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006391 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006392
6393
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006394http-check send-state
6395 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6397 yes | no | yes | yes
6398 Arguments : none
6399
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006400 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006401 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006402 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6403 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6404 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006405
6406 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6407 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6408 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6409 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6410 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006411 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6412 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6413 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6414
6415 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6416 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6417 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6418
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006419 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6420 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6421 checked in multiple backends.
6422
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006423 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006424 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6425
6426 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6427 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6428 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6429 one fails.
6430
6431 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6432 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6433 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6434
6435 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6436 server's queue.
6437
6438 Example of a header received by the application server :
6439 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6440 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6441
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006442 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6443 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006444
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006445
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006446http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6447http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006448 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006449 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6450 yes | no | yes | yes
6451
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006452 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006453 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6454 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6455 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6456 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6457 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6458 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6459 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6460 and '-'.
6461
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006462 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6463 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006464 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006465 conditions.
6466
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006467 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6468
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006469 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6470 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6471
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006472 Examples :
6473 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006474 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006475
6476
6477http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006478 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006479 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6480 yes | no | yes | yes
6481
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006482 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006483 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6484 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6485 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6486 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6487 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6488 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6489 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6490 and '-'.
6491
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006492 Examples :
6493 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006495
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006496http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6497 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6498 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6499 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6500 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6502 yes | yes | yes | yes
6503 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006504 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006505 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006506 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006507 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006508
6509 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6510 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6511 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6512 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6513
6514 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6515 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6516 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6517 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6518
6519 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6520 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6521 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6522 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6523 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6524 chroot is performed.
6525
6526 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6527 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6528 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6529 considered.
6530
6531 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6532 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6533 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6534 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6535 considered as a raw string.
6536
6537 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6538 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6539 "content-type".
6540
6541 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6542 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6543 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6544 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6545 evaluated as a log-format string.
6546
6547 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6548 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6549 argument to "content-type".
6550
6551 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6552 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6553 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6554 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6555
6556 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6557 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6558 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6559 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6560 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6561 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6562 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6563 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6564
6565 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6566 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6567 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6568
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006569 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6570 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6571 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6572 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6573 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6574
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006575 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6576 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6577
6578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006579http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006580 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6581
6582 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006583 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006584
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006585 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6586 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6587 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6588 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6589 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006590
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006591 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6592 supported:
6593 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6594 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6595 - allow
6596 - auth [realm <realm>]
6597 - cache-use <name>
6598 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6599 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6600 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6601 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6602 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6603 - disable-l7-retry
6604 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6605 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6606 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6607 - redirect <rule>
6608 - reject
6609 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6610 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6611 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6612 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6613 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6614 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
6615 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6616 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6617 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6618 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6619 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01006620 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006621 - set-dst <expr>
6622 - set-dst-port <expr>
6623 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6624 - set-log-level <level>
6625 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6626 - set-mark <mark>
6627 - set-method <fmt>
6628 - set-nice <nice>
6629 - set-path <fmt>
6630 - set-pathq <fmt>
6631 - set-priority-class <expr>
6632 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6633 - set-query <fmt>
6634 - set-src <expr>
6635 - set-src-port <expr>
6636 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6637 - set-tos <tos>
6638 - set-uri <fmt>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006639 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6640 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006641 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01006642 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006643 - strict-mode { on | off }
6644 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6645 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6646 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6647 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6648 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6649 - use-service <service-name>
6650 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6651 - wait-for-handshake
6652 - cache-use <name>
6653
6654 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006656 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006657
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006658 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6659 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6660 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6661 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6662 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6663 a defaults section defining such rules.
6664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006665 Example:
6666 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6667 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6668 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006670 http-request allow if nagios
6671 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6672 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6673 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006675 Example:
6676 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6677 acl add path /addacl
6678 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006680 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006682 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6683 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006685 Example:
6686 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6687 acl setmap path /setmap
6688 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006690 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006692 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6693 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006694
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006695 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6696 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006698http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006700 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6701 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6702 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6703 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6704 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6705 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6706 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6707 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006709http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006711 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6712 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6713 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6714 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6715 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6716 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6717 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6718 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006722 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006723 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006725http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006726
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006727 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6728 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6729 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6730 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6731 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006732
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006733 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6734 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6735 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6736 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6737 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6738 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6739 instead.
6740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006741 Example:
6742 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6743 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006744
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006745http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006746
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006747 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006748
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006749http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6750 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006751
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006752 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6753 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6754 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6755 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6756 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6757 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6758 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6759 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6760 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006761
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006762 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6763 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6764 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006765 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6766
6767 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6768 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6769 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6770 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006771
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006772http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006774 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6775 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6776 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6777 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6778 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6779 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006780
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006781http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006782
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006783 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6784 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6785 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6786 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6787 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006788
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006789http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006790
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006791 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6792 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6793 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6794 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6795 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6796 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006797
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006798http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6799http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6800 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6801 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6802 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6803 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006804
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006805 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6806 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6807 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006808 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006809 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6810 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6811 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006812 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006813 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006814
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006815http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6816 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6817 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6818 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6819
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006820http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6821 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006822
6823 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6824 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6825 pointed by <resolvers>.
6826 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6827 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6828 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6829 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6830 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6831 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6832 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6833 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6834 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6835 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemand1ef24602022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006836 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6837 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006838
6839 Example:
6840 resolvers mydns
6841 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6842 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6843 timeout retry 1s
6844 hold valid 10s
6845 hold nx 3s
6846 hold other 3s
6847 hold obsolete 0s
6848 accepted_payload_size 8192
6849
6850 frontend fe
6851 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandb5c2cd42022-08-26 16:48:07 +02006852 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),host_only
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006853 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6854
6855 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6856 # which mean DNS resolution error
6857 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6858
6859 default_backend be
6860
6861 backend b_503
6862 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6863 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6864 # 503 error page to end users
6865
6866 backend be
6867 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6868 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6869 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6870 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6871 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6872
6873 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6874 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6875
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006876http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6877
6878 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6879 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6880 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6881 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006882 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6883 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006884
6885 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6886
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006887http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006888http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006889http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006890http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006891http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006892http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006893http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006894http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6895http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006896
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006897 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6898
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006899 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006900 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6901 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6902 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6903 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006904
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006905 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6906 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6907 the supported backend.
6908
6909 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6910 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6911 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6912 number of segments in the path.
6913
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006914 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6915 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6916 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6917 when improperly combined.
6918
6919 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6920 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6921 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6922 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6923 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6924
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006925 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006926
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006927 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6928
6929 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6930 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6931
6932 Example:
6933 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6934
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006935 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6936
6937 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6938 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6939
6940 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6941 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6942
6943 Example:
6944 - /#foo -> /
6945
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006946 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6947 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006948
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006949 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6950 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6951
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006952 Example:
6953 - /. -> /
6954 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6955 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6956 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006957
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006958 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6959 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6960
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006961 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006962 their preceding segment.
6963
6964 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6965 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6966
6967 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6968 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006969
6970 Example:
6971 - /foo/../ -> /
6972 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6973 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6974 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006975 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006976 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006977 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006978
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006979 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6980 removed as well:
6981
6982 Example:
6983 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6984 - /bar/../../ -> /
6985
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006986 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6987 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006988
6989 Example:
6990 - // -> /
6991 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6992
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006993 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6994 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6995
6996 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6997 ".", "_", and "~".
6998
6999 Example:
7000 - /%61dmin -> /admin
7001 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
7002 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
7003 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
7004
7005 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7006 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7007
7008 Example:
7009 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
7010 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
7011
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007012 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02007013 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02007014
7015 Example:
7016 - /%6f -> /%6F
7017 - /%zz -> /%zz
7018
7019 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7020 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7021
7022 Example:
7023 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
7024
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007025 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02007026 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
7027 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
7028
7029 Example:
7030 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
7031 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
7032 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
7033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007034http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007035
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007036 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
7037 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
7038 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
7039 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
7040 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007042http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007044 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
7045 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
7046 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
7047 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007049http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7050 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007051
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007052 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007053 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
7054 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
7055 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
7056 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
7057 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02007058
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007059 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
7060 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
7061 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
7062 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
7063 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007064
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007065 Example:
7066 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
7067
7068 # applied to:
7069 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7070
7071 # outputs:
7072 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7073
7074 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007075
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007076 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
7077
7078 # applied to:
7079 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007080
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007081 # outputs:
7082 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007083
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007084http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7085 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7086
7087 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
7088 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02007089 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
7090 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
7091 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007092
7093 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7094 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7095 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
7096
7097 Example:
7098 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7099 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
7100
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007101 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
7102 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
7103 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
7104 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
7105
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007106http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7107 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7108
7109 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
7110 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
7111 query-string are replaced.
7112
7113 Example:
7114 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
7115 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
7116
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007117http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7118 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7119
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007120 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
7121 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
7122 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
7123 against.
7124
7125 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7126 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7127 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007128
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007129 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
7130 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
7131 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
7132 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
7133 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
7134 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
7135 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
7136 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
7137 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007138 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
7139 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007140
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007141 Example:
7142 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
7143 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007144
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007145 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7146 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007148http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7149 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007150
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007151 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
7152 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
7153 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
7154 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007155
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007156 Example:
7157 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007158
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007159 # applied to:
7160 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007161
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007162 # outputs:
7163 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007164
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007165http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7166 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7167 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007168 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007169 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7170
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007171 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007172 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7173 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007174 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007175 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007176 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007177 are followed to create the response :
7178
7179 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7180 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7181 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7182 ignored.
7183
7184 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7185 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007186 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007187 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7188 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007189
7190 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7191 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7192 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007193 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007194 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007195
7196 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7197 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7198 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007199 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007200 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007201 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007202
7203 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7204 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7205 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7206 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7207 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7208 as a raw content.
7209
7210 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7211 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7212 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7213 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7214 considered as a raw string.
7215
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007216 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007217 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7218 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7219 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7220
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007221 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7222 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007223 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007224
7225 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7226
7227 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007228 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007229 if { path /ping }
7230
7231 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
7232 if { path /favicon.ico }
7233
7234 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
7235 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
7236 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
7237
Willy Tarreau5a72d032023-01-02 18:15:20 +01007238http-request sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7239 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7240
7241 This action increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
7242 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> by the value of
7243 either integer <int> or the integer evaluation of expression <expr>. Integers
7244 and expressions are limited to unsigned 32-bit values. If an error occurs,
7245 this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues. <idx> is an
7246 integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer between 0 and 2. It also
7247 silently fails if the there is no GPC stored at this index. The entry in the
7248 table is refreshed even if the value is zero. The 'gpc_rate' is automatically
7249 adjusted to reflect the average growth rate of the gpc value.
7250
7251 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7252 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7253 There is no equivalent function for legacy data types, but if the value is
7254 always 1, please see 'sc-inc-gpc()', 'sc-inc-gpc0()' and 'sc-inc-gpc1()'.
7255 There is no way to decrement the value either, but it is possible to store
7256 exact values in a General Purpose Tag using 'sc-set-gpt()' instead.
7257
7258 The main use of this action is to count scores or total volumes (e.g.
7259 estimated danger per source IP reported by the server or a WAF, total
7260 uploaded bytes, etc).
7261
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007262http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7263
7264 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7265 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7266 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7267 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7268 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7269 at this index.
7270 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7271 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7272
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007273http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7274http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007276 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7277 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7278 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007279
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007280http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7281 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7282 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7283 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7284 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7285 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7286 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7287 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7288 at this index.
7289 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7290 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7291
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007292http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7293 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007294
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007295 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7296 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7297 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7298 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007299
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007300http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7301 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7302
7303 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7304 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7305 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7306 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7307 agent name must be used.
7308
7309 Arguments:
7310 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7311
7312 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7313 configuration.
7314
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007315http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
7316 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007317
7318 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7319 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7320 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7321 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7322 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7323 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7324 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7325 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7326
7327 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7328 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7329 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7330
7331 Arguments:
7332 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7333 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7334 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7335 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7336
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007337 <size> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7338 bytes.
7339
7340 <time> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in
7341 milliseconds.
7342
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007343 Example:
7344 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7345 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7346
7347 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007349http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007351 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7352 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7353 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7354 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7355 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007357 Arguments:
7358 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7359 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007361 Example:
7362 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7363 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007365 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7366 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007368http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007369
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007370 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7371 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7372 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007374 Arguments:
7375 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7376 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007378 Example:
7379 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7380 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007382 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7383 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7384 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007386http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007388 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7389 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7390 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7391 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7392 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007394 Example:
7395 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7396 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7397 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7398 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7399 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7400 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7401 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7402 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7403 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007405http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007407 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7408 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7409 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7410 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7411 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007413http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7414 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007415
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007416 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7417 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7418 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7419 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7420 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7421 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7422 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7423 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7424 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007426http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007427
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007428 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7429 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7430 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7431 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7432 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7433 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7434 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007435 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7436 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007437
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007438http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007440 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7441 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7442 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007444http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007446 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7447 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7448 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7449 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7450 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7451 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7452 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7453 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007454
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007455http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007456
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007457 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7458 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7459 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7460 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7461 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7462 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007463
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007464 Example :
7465 # prepend the host name before the path
7466 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007467
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007468http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7469
7470 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7471 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7472 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7473
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007474http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007475
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007476 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7477 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7478 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7479 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7480 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007482http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007483
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007484 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7485 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7486 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7487 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7488 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7489 values have higher priority.
7490 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7491 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7492 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7493 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7494 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007496http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007498 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7499 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7500 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7501 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7502 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7503 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7504 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007505
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007506 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007507
7508 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007509 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7510 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007511
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007512http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7513 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7514 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7515 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007516 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7517 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007518
7519 Arguments :
7520 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7521 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007522
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007523 See also "option forwardfor".
7524
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007525 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007526 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7527 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7528
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007529 # After the masking this will track connections
7530 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7531 http-request track-sc0 src
7532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007533 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7534 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7535
7536http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7537
7538 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7539 expression.
7540
7541 Arguments:
7542 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7543 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007544
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007545 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007546 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7547 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7548
7549 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7550 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7551 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7552
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007553http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007554 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7555
7556 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7557 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7558 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7559 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7560 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7561
7562 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7563 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7564 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7565 results.
7566
7567 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007568 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7569 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007571http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7572
7573 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7574 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7575 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7576 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7577 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7578 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7579 information from the request.
7580
7581 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7582
7583http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7584
7585 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7586 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet84cdbe42022-11-22 15:41:48 +01007587 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
7588 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
7589 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
7590 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
7591 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007592 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7593
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007594http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7595http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007596
7597 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7598 inline.
7599
7600 Arguments:
7601 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7602 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7603 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7604 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7605 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7606 (request and response)
7607 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7608 processing
7609 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7610 processing
7611 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7612 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7613 and '_'.
7614
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007615 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7616 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007617 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007618 conditions.
7619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007620 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7621 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007622
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007623 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7624 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7625
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007626 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007627 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007628 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
7629
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007630http-request silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007631
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007632 This stops the evaluation of the rules and removes the client-facing
7633 connection in a configurable way: When called without the rst-ttl argument,
7634 we try to prevent sending any FIN or RST packet back to the client by
7635 using TCP_REPAIR. If this fails (mainly because of missing privileges),
7636 we fall back to sending a RST packet with a TTL of 1.
7637
7638 The effect is that the client still sees an established connection while
7639 there is none on HAProxy, saving resources. However, stateful equipment
7640 placed between the HAProxy and the client (firewalls, proxies,
7641 load balancers) will also keep the established connection in their
7642 session tables.
7643
7644 The optional rst-ttl changes this behaviour: TCP_REPAIR is not used,
7645 and a RST packet with a configurable TTL is sent. When set to a
7646 reasonable value, the RST packet travels through your own equipment,
7647 deleting the connection in your middle-boxes, but does not arrive at
7648 the client. Future packets from the client will then be dropped
7649 already by your middle-boxes. These "local RST"s protect your resources,
7650 but not the client's. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007651
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007652http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007653
7654 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7655 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7656 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7657 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7658 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007659 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007660 processing.
7661
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007662 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007663 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7664 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7665 rules evaluation.
7666
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007667http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7668http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7669 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7670 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7671 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7672 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007673
7674 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7675 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7676 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007677 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7678 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7679 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7680 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7681 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7682 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007683 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007684 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7685 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7686 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007687 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007688 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7689 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7690 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7691 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7692 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007693
7694http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7695http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7696http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7697
7698 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7699 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01007700 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set by the
7701 global "tune.stick-counters" setting, which defaults to MAX_SESS_STKCTR if
7702 set at build time (it is reported in haproxy -vv) and which defaults to 3,
7703 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (tune.stick-counters-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007704 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7705 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7706 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7707 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7708 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7709 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7710 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7711
7712 Arguments :
7713 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7714 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7715 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7716 select which table entry to update the counters.
7717
7718 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7719 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7720 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7721 that table until the session ends.
7722
7723 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7724 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7725 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7726 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7727 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7728 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7729 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7730 useful information.
7731
7732 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7733 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7734 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7735 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7736 checks that make use of it.
7737
7738http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7739
7740 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007741
7742 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007743 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007744
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007745http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7746
7747 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7748 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7749 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7750 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7751 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7752 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7753
7754 Arguments :
7755 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7756
7757 Example:
7758 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7759
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007760http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7761 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7762
7763 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7764 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7765 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7766 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7767 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7768 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7769 http-buffer-request".
7770
7771 Arguments :
7772
7773 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7774 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7775
7776 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007777 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007778 bytes.
7779
7780 Example:
7781 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7782
7783 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7784
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007785http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007786
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007787 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7788 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7789 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007790
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007791
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007792http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007793 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7794
7795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007796 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007797
7798 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7799 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7800 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7801 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7802 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7803 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7804
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007805 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7806 supported:
7807 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7808 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7809 - allow
7810 - cache-store <name>
7811 - capture <sample> id <id>
7812 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7813 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7814 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7815 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7816 - redirect <rule>
7817 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7818 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7819 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
7820 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7821 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7822 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7823 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7824 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7825 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007826 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007827 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7828 - set-log-level <level>
7829 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7830 - set-mark <mark>
7831 - set-nice <nice>
7832 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7833 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007834 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
7835 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +01007836 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007837 - strict-mode { on | off }
7838 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7839 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7840 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7841 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7842 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7843
7844 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007846 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007847
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007848 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7849 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7850 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7851 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7852 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7853 a defaults section defining such rules.
7854
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007855 Example:
7856 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007857
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007858 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007859
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007860 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7861 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007863 Example:
7864 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007865
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007866 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007867
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007868 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7869 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007870
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007871 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7872 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007873
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007874http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007875
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007876 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7877 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007878
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007879http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007880
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007881 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007882 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7883 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007884
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007885http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007886
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007887 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7888 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007889
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007890http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007891
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007892 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007893
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007894http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007895
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007896 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7897 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7898 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7899 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7900 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7901 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7902 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007903
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007904 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7905 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7906 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7907 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7908 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007909
7910 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7911 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7912 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7913 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007914
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007915http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007916
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007917 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7918 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007919
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007920http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007921
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007922 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7923 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007925http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007926
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007927 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7928 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007929
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007930http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7931http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7932 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7933 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7934 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7935 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007936
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007937 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7938 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7939 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007940 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007941 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7942 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7943 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007944 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007945 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007947http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007949 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7950 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7951 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7952 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7953 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7954 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007955
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007956http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7957 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007958
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007959 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7960 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007962 Example:
7963 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007964
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007965 # applied to:
7966 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007968 # outputs:
7969 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007970
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007971 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007973http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7974 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007975
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007976 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007977 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007978
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007979 Example:
7980 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007982 # applied to:
7983 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007984
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007985 # outputs:
7986 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007987
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007988http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7989 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7990 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007991 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007992 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7993
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007994 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
7995 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
7996 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007997
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007998http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007999http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8000http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08008001
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008002 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
8003 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
8004 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
8005 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008006
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02008007http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008008 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01008009http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8010 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008011
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008012 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
8013 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
8014 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008015
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02008016http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
8017 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008018
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008019 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
8020 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02008021
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008022http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
8023 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02008024
8025 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
8026 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
8027 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
8028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008029http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008030
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008031 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
8032 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
8033 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
8034 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008036http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8037
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008038 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
8039 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008040
8041http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8042
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008043 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8044 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008045
8046http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8047
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008048 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
8049 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
8050 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008051
8052http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8053
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008054 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
8055 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008056
8057http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8058 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8059
8060 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
8061 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
8062 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
8063 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008064
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008065 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008066 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
8067 http-response set-status 431
8068 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
8069 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008071http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008073 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008074 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
8075 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008076
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01008077http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8078http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008079
8080 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008081 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
8082 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008083
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008084http-response silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008085
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008086 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
8087 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008088 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
8089 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008090
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008091http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008092
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008093 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
8094 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008096http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8097http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8098http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008099
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008100 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
8101 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
8102 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008103
8104http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8105
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008106 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008107 about <var-name>.
8108
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008109http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8110 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8111
8112 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008113 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
8114 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008115
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02008116
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008117http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
8118 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
8119
8120 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8121 yes | no | yes | yes
8122
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008123 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008124 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
8125 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
8126 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008127
8128 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
8129
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008130 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
8131 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
8132 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
8133 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
8134 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
8135 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
8136 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008137 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008138 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
8139 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008140
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008141 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
8142 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
8143 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
8144 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
8145 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
8146 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
8147 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02008148 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
8149 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
8150 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
8151 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
8152 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
8153 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008154
8155 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
8156 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
8157 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
8158 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
8159 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
8160 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
8161 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
8162 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02008163 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008164 downsides of rare connection failures.
8165
8166 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
8167 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
8168 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
8169 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
8170 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
8171 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008172 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008173 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
8174 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
8175 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
8176 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
8177 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
8178
8179 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008180 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
8181 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
8182 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
8183 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008184
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008185 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
8186 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008187
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01008188 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008189
8190 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
8191 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
8192 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
8193
Willy Tarreau44fce8b2022-11-25 09:17:18 +01008194 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
8195 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
8196 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
8197 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
8198 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
8199 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
8200 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
8201 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
8202 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
8203 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
8204 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
8205
8206 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
8207 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
8208 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
8209 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
8210 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
8211
8212 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
8213 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008214
8215
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008216http-send-name-header [<header>]
8217 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8219 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008220 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008221 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
8222
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02008223 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
8224 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
8225 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
8226 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
8227 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
8228 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
8229 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
8230 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
8231 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
8232 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
8233 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
8234 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
8235 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
8236 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
8237 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
8238 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008239
8240 See also : "server"
8241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008242id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008243 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
8244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8245 no | yes | yes | yes
8246 Arguments : none
8247
8248 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
8249 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
8250 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008251
8252
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008253ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
8254 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
8255 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01008256 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008257
8258 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
8259 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
8260 and running).
8261
8262 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
8263 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
8264 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008265 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008266 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
8267
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008268 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
8269 "unless" condition is met.
8270
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008271 Example:
8272 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8273 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8274 ignore-persist if url_static
8275
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008276 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
8277
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008278load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
8279 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
8280 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8281 yes | no | yes | yes
8282
8283 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
8284 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
8285 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008286 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008287 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008288 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
8289 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
8290 over the stats socket and redirect output.
8291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008292 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008293 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02008294 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008295
8296 Arguments:
8297 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
8298 named "server-state-file".
8299
8300 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
8301 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
8302 name is used as a file name.
8303
8304 none don't load any stat for this backend
8305
8306 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008307 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
8308 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
8309 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008310 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008311 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008312
8313 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8314 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8315
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008316 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008317
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008318 global
8319 stats socket /tmp/socket
8320 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008321
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008322 defaults
8323 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008324
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008325 backend bk
8326 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8327 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008328
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008329
8330 Then one can run :
8331
8332 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8333
8334 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8335
8336 1
8337 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8338 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8339 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8340
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008341 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008342
8343 global
8344 stats socket /tmp/socket
8345 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8346
8347 defaults
8348 load-server-state-from-file local
8349
8350 backend bk
8351 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8352 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8353
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008354
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008355 Then one can run :
8356
8357 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8358
8359 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8360
8361 1
8362 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8363 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8364 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8365
8366 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8367 "show servers state"
8368
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008369
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008370log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008371log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008372 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008373no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008374 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8376 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008377
8378 Prefix :
8379 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8380 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8381 prefix does not allow arguments.
8382
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008383 Arguments :
8384 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8385 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8386 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8387 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8388 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8389 parameter.
8390
8391 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8392 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8393
8394 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8395 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8396 standard syslog port).
8397
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008398 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8399 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8400 standard syslog port).
8401
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008402 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8403 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8404 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008405 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008406
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008407 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8408 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8409 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8410 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8411 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8412 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8413 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8414 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8415 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8416 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8417 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8418 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008419 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008420 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8421 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8422 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008423 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8424 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008425
8426 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8427 and "fd@2", see above.
8428
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008429 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8430 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8431 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8432 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8433 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8434 having the logs instantly available.
8435
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008436 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8437 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8438 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8439
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008440 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8441 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008442
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008443 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8444 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8445 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8446 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8447 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8448 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8449 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8450 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8451 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8452 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008453 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008454
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008455 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8456 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8457 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8458 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8459 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8460
8461 <sample_size>
8462 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8463 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8464 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8465 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8466 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8467
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008468 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8469 one of the following :
8470
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008471 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8472 field is stripped. This is the default.
8473 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8474 rfc3164.
8475
8476 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008477 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8478
8479 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8480 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8481
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008482 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8483 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8484 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8485 designed to be used with a local log server.
8486
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008487 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8488 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8489 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8490 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8491 systemd logger consumes.
8492
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008493 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8494 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8495 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8496 used with a local log server.
8497
8498 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8499 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8500 designed to be used with a local log server.
8501
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008502 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8503 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8504 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8505 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8506
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008507 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8508
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008509 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8510 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8511 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8512
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008513 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8514 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8515 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8516 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008517
8518 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8519 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8520 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008521 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8522 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8523 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8524 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8525 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008526
8527 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8528
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008529 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8530 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8531 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008532
8533 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8534 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8535 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8536 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8537
8538 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8539 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008540
8541 Example :
8542 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008543 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8544 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8545 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008546 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008547 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8548 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008549 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008550
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008551
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008552log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008553 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8554 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8555 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008556
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008557 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8558 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8559 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8560 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8561 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008562 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8563 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008564
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008565 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8566 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008567
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008568log-format-sd <string>
8569 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8570 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8571 yes | yes | yes | no
8572
8573 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8574 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8575 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8576 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8577 which covers the log format string in depth.
8578
8579 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8580 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8581
8582 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8583 log format to "rfc5424".
8584
8585 Example :
8586 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8587
8588
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008589log-tag <string>
8590 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8591 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8592 yes | yes | yes | yes
8593
8594 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8595 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008596 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008597 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8598 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8599 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8600 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8601 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8602 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008603
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008604max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8605 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8606 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8607 yes | no | yes | yes
8608
8609 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8610 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8611 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8612 servers.
8613
8614 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008615 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008616 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8617 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8618 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008619 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008620 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8621 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8622 picking a different server.
8623
8624 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8625 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8626 even if they have to be queued.
8627
8628 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8629 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8630
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008631max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8632 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8633 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8634 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008635
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008636maxconn <conns>
8637 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8639 yes | yes | yes | no
8640 Arguments :
8641 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8642 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8643 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8644 closes.
8645
8646 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008647 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008648 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8649 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008650 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8651 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8652 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8653 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008654
8655 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8656 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8657 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8658
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008659 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8660 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008661
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008662 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8663
8664
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008665mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008666 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8668 yes | yes | yes | yes
8669 Arguments :
8670 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8671 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8672 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8673 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8674
8675 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8676 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8677 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8678 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8679 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8680
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008681 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8682 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8683 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008684
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008685 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008686 defaults http_instances
8687 mode http
8688
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008689
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008690monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008691 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8693 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008694 Arguments :
8695 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8696 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008697 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008698 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8699 backend and its backup.
8700
8701 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8702 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8703 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8704 servers in a list of backends.
8705
8706 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8707 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8708 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008709 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008710 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8711 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008712 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008713 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8714 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008715
8716 Example:
8717 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008718 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008719 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8720 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8721 monitor-uri /site_alive
8722 monitor fail if site_dead
8723
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008724 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008725
8726
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008727monitor-uri <uri>
8728 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8730 yes | yes | yes | no
8731 Arguments :
8732 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8733 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8734
8735 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8736 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8737 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8738 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8739 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8740 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8741 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8742 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8743
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008744 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008745 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8746 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau7fe0c622022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008747 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8748 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8749 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008750 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8751 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8752 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008753
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008754 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8755 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8756 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8757 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8758
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008759 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008760 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008761 frontend www
8762 mode http
8763 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8764
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008765 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008766
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008767
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008768option abortonclose
8769no option abortonclose
8770 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8772 yes | no | yes | yes
8773 Arguments : none
8774
8775 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8776 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8777 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8778 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008779 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008780 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8781 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8782 encountered while delivering the response.
8783
8784 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8785 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8786 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8787 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8788 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8789 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008790 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008791 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008792 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008793 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8794 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8795 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8796
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008797 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8798 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008799 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8800 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8801 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8802 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8803 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8804 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008805 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008806
8807 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8808 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8809
8810 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8811
8812
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008813option accept-invalid-http-request
8814no option accept-invalid-http-request
8815 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8817 yes | yes | yes | no
8818 Arguments : none
8819
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008820 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008821 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008822 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008823 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8824 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8825 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8826 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8827 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008828 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8829 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8830 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8831 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008832 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008833 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008834 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02008835 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
8836 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008837
8838 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8839 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8840 been confirmed.
8841
8842 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8843 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008844 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8845 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008846 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8847
8848 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8849 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8850
8851 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8852 stats socket.
8853
8854
8855option accept-invalid-http-response
8856no option accept-invalid-http-response
8857 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8859 yes | no | yes | yes
8860 Arguments : none
8861
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008862 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008863 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008864 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008865 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8866 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8867 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8868 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8869 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008870 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8871 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8872 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008873
8874 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8875 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8876 been confirmed.
8877
8878 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8879 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8880 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8881 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8882
8883 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8884 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8885
8886 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8887 stats socket.
8888
8889
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008890option allbackups
8891no option allbackups
8892 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8894 yes | no | yes | yes
8895 Arguments : none
8896
8897 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8898 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8899 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8900 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8901 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8902 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8903 order between the backup servers anymore.
8904
8905 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8906 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8907
8908 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8909 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8910
8911
8912option checkcache
8913no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008914 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8916 yes | no | yes | yes
8917 Arguments : none
8918
8919 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8920 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008921 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008922 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8923 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008924 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008925
8926 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008927 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008928 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008929 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8930 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008931 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008932 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008933 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8934 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008935 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008936 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8937 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008938 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008939 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8940 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8941 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8942 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8943 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8944 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8945 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8946 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8947 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8948
8949 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008950 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8951 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8952 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8953 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008954
8955 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8956 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008957 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008958 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008959
8960 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8961 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8962
8963
8964option clitcpka
8965no option clitcpka
8966 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8968 yes | yes | yes | no
8969 Arguments : none
8970
8971 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8972 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008973 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008974 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8975
8976 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8977 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8978 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8979 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8980
8981 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8982 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8983 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8984 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8985 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8986
8987 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8988
8989 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8990 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8991 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8992
8993 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8994 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8995
8996 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8997
8998
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008999option contstats
9000 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
9001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9002 yes | yes | yes | no
9003 Arguments : none
9004
9005 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
9006 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
9007 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009008 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01009009 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
9010 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
9011 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
9012 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
9013 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009014
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009015option disable-h2-upgrade
9016no option disable-h2-upgrade
9017 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
9018 connection.
9019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9020 yes | yes | yes | no
9021 Arguments : none
9022
9023 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
9024 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
9025 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
9026 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01009027 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
9028 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
9029 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
9030 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
9031 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
9032 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009033
9034 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9035 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009036
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009037option dontlog-normal
9038no option dontlog-normal
9039 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
9040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9041 yes | yes | yes | no
9042 Arguments : none
9043
9044 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
9045 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
9046 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
9047 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
9048 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
9049 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
9050 logged.
9051
9052 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
9053 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
9054 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
9055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009056 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009057 logging.
9058
9059
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009060option dontlognull
9061no option dontlognull
9062 Enable or disable logging of null connections
9063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9064 yes | yes | yes | no
9065 Arguments : none
9066
9067 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
9068 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
9069 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
9070 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
9071 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
9072 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009073 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
9074 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
9075 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009076
9077 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009078 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009079 would not be logged.
9080
9081 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9082 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9083
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009084 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009085 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009086
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009087option forwarded [ proto ]
9088 [ host | host-expr <host_expr> ]
9089 [ by | by-expr <by_expr> ] [ by_port | by_port-expr <by_port_expr>]
9090 [ for | for-expr <for_expr> ] [ for_port | for_port-expr <for_port_expr>]
9091no option forwarded
9092 Enable insertion of the rfc 7239 forwarded header in requests sent to servers
9093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9094 yes | no | yes | yes
9095 Arguments :
9096 <host_expr> optional argument to specify a custom sample expression
9097 those result will be used as 'host' parameter value
9098
9099 <by_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9100 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodename value
9101
9102 <for_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9103 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodename value
9104
9105 <by_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9106 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodeport value
9107
9108 <for_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9109 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodeport value
9110
9111
9112 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, servers are loosing some request
9113 context (request origin: client ip address, protocol used...)
9114
9115 A common way to address this limitation is to use the well known
9116 x-forward-for and x-forward-* friends to expose some of this context to the
9117 underlying servers/applications.
9118 While this use to work and is widely deployed, it is not officially supported
9119 by the IETF and can be the root of some interoperability as well as security
9120 issues.
9121
9122 To solve this, a new HTTP extension has been described by the IETF:
9123 forwarded header (RFC7239).
9124 More information here: https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html
9125
9126 The use of this single header allow to convey multiple informations
9127 within the same header, and most importantly, fixes the proxy chaining
9128 issue. (the rfc allows for multiple chained proxies to append their own
9129 values to an already existing header).
9130
9131 This option may be specified in defaults, listen or backend section, but it
9132 will be ignored for frontend sections.
9133
9134 Setting option forwarded without arguments results in using default implicit
9135 behavior.
9136 Default behavior enables proto parameter and injects original client ip.
9137
9138 The equivalent explicit/manual configuration would be:
9139 option forwarded proto for
9140
9141 The keyword 'by' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9142 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9143 'by' value will be set to proxy ip (destination address)
9144 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'by' will be set to
9145 "unknown".
9146
9147 The keyword 'by-expr' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9148 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9149 'by' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9150 <by_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9151
9152 The keyword 'for' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9153 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9154 'for' value will be set to client ip (source address)
9155 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'for' will be set to
9156 "unknown".
9157
9158 The keyword 'for-expr' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9159 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9160 'for' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9161 <for_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9162
9163 The keyword 'by_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9164 'by' parameter. 'by_port' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9165 it will be ignored.
9166 "nodeport" will be set to proxy (destination) port if available,
9167 otherwise it will be ignored.
9168
9169 The keyword 'by_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9170 'by' parameter. 'by_port-expr' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9171 it will be ignored.
9172 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9173 <by_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9174
9175 The keyword 'for_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9176 'for' parameter. 'for_port' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9177 it will be ignored.
9178 "nodeport" will be set to client (source) port if available,
9179 otherwise it will be ignored.
9180
9181 The keyword 'for_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9182 'for' parameter. 'for_port-expr' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9183 it will be ignored.
9184 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9185 <for_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9186
9187 Examples :
9188 # Those servers want the ip address and protocol of the client request
9189 # Resulting header would look like this:
9190 # forwarded: proto=http;for=127.0.0.1
9191 backend www_default
9192 mode http
9193 option forwarded
9194 #equivalent to: option forwarded proto for
9195
9196 # Those servers want the requested host and hashed client ip address
9197 # as well as client source port (you should use seed for xxh32 if ensuring
9198 # ip privacy is a concern)
9199 # Resulting header would look like this:
9200 # forwarded: host="haproxy.org";for="_000000007F2F367E:60138"
9201 backend www_host
9202 mode http
9203 option forwarded host for-expr src,xxh32,hex for_port
9204
9205 # Those servers want custom data in host, for and by parameters
9206 # Resulting header would look like this:
9207 # forwarded: host="host.com";by=_haproxy;for="[::1]:10"
9208 backend www_custom
9209 mode http
9210 option forwarded host-expr str(host.com) by-expr str(_haproxy) for for_port-expr int(10)
9211
9212 # Those servers want random 'for' obfuscated identifiers for request
9213 # tracing purposes while protecting sensitive IP information
9214 # Resulting header would look like this:
9215 # forwarded: for=_000000002B1F4D63
9216 backend www_for_hide
9217 mode http
9218 option forwarded for-expr rand,hex
9219
9220 See also : "option forwardfor", "option originalto"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009221
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009222option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009223 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
9224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9225 yes | yes | yes | yes
9226 Arguments :
9227 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9228 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009229 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009230 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009231
9232 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
9233 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
9234 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
9235 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
9236 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
9237 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
9238 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009239 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
9240 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9241 possible that the client has already brought one.
9242
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009243 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009244 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009245 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009246 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009247 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009248 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009249
9250 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9251 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9252 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
9253 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
9254 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
9255 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01009256 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009257
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009258 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
9259 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009260 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009261 are under the control of the end-user.
9262
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009263 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009264 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9265 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009266 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
9267 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
9268 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009269
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02009270 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009271 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
9272 frontend www
9273 mode http
9274 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
9275
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009276 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
9277 backend www
9278 mode http
9279 option forwardfor header X-Client
9280
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009281 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009282 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009283
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009284
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02009285option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9286no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9287 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
9288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9289 yes | yes | yes | no
9290 Arguments : none
9291
9292 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9293 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9294 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9295 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9296 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9297 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9298 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9299
9300 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
9301 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
9302 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
9303 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9304 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
9305 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9306 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9307 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
9308 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9309 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9310
9311 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
9312
9313 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9314 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9315
9316 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
9317 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9318
9319
9320option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9321no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9322 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
9323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9324 yes | no | yes | yes
9325 Arguments : none
9326
9327 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9328 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9329 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9330 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9331 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9332 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9333 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9334
9335 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
9336 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
9337 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
9338 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9339 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
9340 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9341 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9342 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
9343 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9344 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9345
9346 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
9347
9348 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9349 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9350
9351 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
9352 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9353
9354
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009355option http-buffer-request
9356no option http-buffer-request
9357 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
9358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9359 yes | yes | yes | yes
9360 Arguments : none
9361
9362 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
9363 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
9364 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
9365 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
9366 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
9367 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01009368 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
9369 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
9370 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
9371 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009372
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02009373 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
9374 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009375
9376
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009377option http-ignore-probes
9378no option http-ignore-probes
9379 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
9380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9381 yes | yes | yes | no
9382 Arguments : none
9383
9384 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
9385 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
9386 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
9387 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
9388 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
9389 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
9390 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
9391 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
9392 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009393 was received over a connection before it was closed;
9394 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009395 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
9396
9397 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
9398 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
9399 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
9400 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
9401 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
9402 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
9403 are often the only way to detect them.
9404
9405 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9406 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9407
9408 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
9409
9410
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009411option http-keep-alive
9412no option http-keep-alive
9413 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
9414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9415 yes | yes | yes | yes
9416 Arguments : none
9417
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009418 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9419 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009420 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9421 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009422 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
9423 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
9424 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009425
9426 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
9427 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009428 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
9429 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
9430 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
9431 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
9432 situations where this option may be useful :
9433
9434 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009435 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009436
9437 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
9438 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
9439
9440 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
9441 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
9442 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
9443 request.
9444
9445 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
9446 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009447 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
9448 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
9449 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009450
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009451 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9452 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9453 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9454 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9455 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9456 not set.
9457
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009458 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9459 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
9460 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009461
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009462 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009463 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01009464 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009465
9466
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009467option http-no-delay
9468no option http-no-delay
9469 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9471 yes | yes | yes | yes
9472 Arguments : none
9473
9474 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9475 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9476 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9477 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9478 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9479 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9480 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009481 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009482 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9483 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9484 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9485 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9486 affected.
9487
9488 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9489 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9490 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9491 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9492 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9493 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9494 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9495 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9496 latency environments.
9497
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009498 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9499
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009500
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009501option http-pretend-keepalive
9502no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009503 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009505 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009506 Arguments : none
9507
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009508 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009509 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
9510 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
9511 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009512 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009513 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
9514 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
9515 consider the response complete.
9516
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009517 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009518 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009519 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009520 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009521 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009522 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
9523
9524 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
9525 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
9526 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
9527 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009528 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
9529 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009530 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
9531
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009532 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
9533 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
9534 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
9535 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
9536 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
9537 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009538
9539 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9540 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9541
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009542 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009543 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009544
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02009545option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
9546 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
9547 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
9548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9549 yes | yes | yes | yes
9550 Arguments :
9551 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
9552 with no FastCGI application configured.
9553
9554 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
9555 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
9556 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
9557
9558 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
9559 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
9560
9561 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
9562 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
9563 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
9564 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
9565 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
9566 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
9567 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
9568 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
9569
9570 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
9571 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009572
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009573option http-server-close
9574no option http-server-close
9575 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
9576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9577 yes | yes | yes | yes
9578 Arguments : none
9579
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009580 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9581 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
9582 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9583 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009584 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
9585 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
9586 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
9587 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
9588 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
9589 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
9590 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
9591 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
9592 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
9593 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
9594 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009595
9596 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9597 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9598 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9599 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009600 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9601 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009602
9603 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9604 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009605 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9606 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9607 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009608
9609 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9610 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9611
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009612 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
9613 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009614
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009615option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009616no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009617 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
9618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9619 yes | yes | yes | no
9620 Arguments : none
9621
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00009622 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009623 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
9624 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
9625 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
9626 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
9627 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009628 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009629
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009630 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009631 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009632 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
9633 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
9634 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009635
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01009636 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
9637 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
9638 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
9639 front of an existing proxy.
9640
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009641 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
9642
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009643 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009644
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009645option httpchk
9646option httpchk <uri>
9647option httpchk <method> <uri>
9648option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009649 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9651 yes | no | yes | yes
9652 Arguments :
9653 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
9654 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
9655 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
9656 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
9657 ones.
9658
9659 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
9660 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
9661 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
9662
9663 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
9664 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
9665 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009666 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009667
9668 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
9669 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
9670 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
9671 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
9672 the lack of any response.
9673
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009674 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
9675 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
9676 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
9677 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
9678
9679 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
9680 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
9681 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009682
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009683 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
9684 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009685 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04009686 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009687 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009688
9689 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009690 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
9691 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
9692 backend https_relay
9693 mode tcp
9694 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
9695 http-check send hdr Host www
9696 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009697
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009698 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
9699 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
9700 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009701
9702
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009703option httpclose
9704no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009705 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9707 yes | yes | yes | yes
9708 Arguments : none
9709
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009710 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9711 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
9712 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9713 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009714 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009715
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009716 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
9717 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009718 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009719 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
9720 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009721
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009722 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
9723 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
9724 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009725
9726 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9727 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009728 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
9729 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9730 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009731
9732 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9733 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9734
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009735 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009736
9737
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009738option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009739 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
9740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009741 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009742 Arguments :
9743 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
9744 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
9745 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009746 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009747 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009748
9749 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9750 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9751 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9752 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9753 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9754 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9755 ports.
9756
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009757 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9758 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009759
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009760 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009762 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009763
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009764option httpslog
9765 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
9766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9767 yes | yes | yes | no
9768
9769 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9770 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9771 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9772 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9773 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9774 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
9775 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
9776
9777 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9778
9779 See also : section 8 about logging.
9780
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009781
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009782option independent-streams
9783no option independent-streams
9784 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9786 yes | yes | yes | yes
9787 Arguments : none
9788
9789 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9790 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9791 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9792 receive data or not.
9793
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009794 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009795 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9796 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9797 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9798 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9799 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9800 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9801 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9802 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9803 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9804 socket buffers.
9805
9806 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9807 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9808 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9809 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9810 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9811
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009812 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009813
9814
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009815option ldap-check
9816 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9818 yes | no | yes | yes
9819 Arguments : none
9820
9821 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9822 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9823 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9824 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9825
9826 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9827 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9828
9829 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9830 configure it.
9831
9832 Example :
9833 option ldap-check
9834
9835 See also : "option httpchk"
9836
9837
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009838option external-check
9839 Use external processes for server health checks
9840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9841 yes | no | yes | yes
9842
9843 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9844 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9845 command".
9846
9847 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9848
9849 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9850
9851
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009852option idle-close-on-response
9853no option idle-close-on-response
9854 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9856 yes | yes | yes | no
9857 Arguments : none
9858
9859 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9860 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9861 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9862 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9863 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9864 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9865 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9866 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9867 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9868
9869 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9870 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9871
9872 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9873 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9874 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9875 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9876
9877 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9878 "hard-stop-after"
9879
9880
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009881option log-health-checks
9882no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009883 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9885 yes | no | yes | yes
9886 Arguments : none
9887
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009888 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9889 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9890 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009891
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009892 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9893 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9894 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9895 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9896 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9897
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009898 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009899 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009900
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009901 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9902 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9903 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009904
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009905
9906option log-separate-errors
9907no option log-separate-errors
9908 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9910 yes | yes | yes | no
9911 Arguments : none
9912
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009913 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009914 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9915 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9916 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9917 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9918 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9919 provides very important information.
9920
9921 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9922 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9923 error logs.
9924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009925 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009926 logging.
9927
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009928
9929option logasap
9930no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009931 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9933 yes | yes | yes | no
9934 Arguments : none
9935
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009936 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9937 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9938 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9939 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9940
9941 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9942 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9943 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9944 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9945 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009946 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009947 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9948 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9949 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9950 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009951 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009952
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009953 Examples :
9954 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9955 mode http
9956 option httplog
9957 option logasap
9958 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9959
9960 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9961 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9962 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9963 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9964
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009965 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009966 logging.
9967
9968
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009969option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009970 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9972 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009973 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009974 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9975 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009976 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9977 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009978
9979 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9980 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009981 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009982 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009983 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9984 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9985 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009986
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009987 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9988 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9989 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009990
9991 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009992 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009993 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9994 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9995 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9996 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9997 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9998 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9999 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
10000
10001 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
10002 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010003
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +020010004 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010005
10006 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
10007 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
10008 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10009 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010010 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010011 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010012
10013 See also: "option httpchk"
10014
10015
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010016option nolinger
10017no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010018 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010019 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10020 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010021 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010022
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010023 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010024 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
10025 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
10026 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
10027 connections.
10028
10029 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
10030 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010031 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
10032 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
10033 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
10034 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
10035 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
10036 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
10037 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
10038 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
10039 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
10040 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
10041 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
10042 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
10043 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010044
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010045 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
10046 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
10047 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
10048 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
10049 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010050
10051 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
10052 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010053 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050010054 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010055 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010056
10057 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10058 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10059
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010060 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
10061 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010062
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010063option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
10064 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
10065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10066 yes | yes | yes | yes
10067 Arguments :
10068 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
10069 matching <network>
10070 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
10071 header name.
10072
10073 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
10074 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
10075 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
10076 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
10077 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
10078 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
10079 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
10080 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
10081 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
10082 possible that the client has already brought one.
10083
10084 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
10085 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
10086 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
10087 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
10088 header and requires different one.
10089
10090 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
10091 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
10092 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +010010093 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
10094 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
10095 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
10096 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
10097 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010098
10099 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
10100 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
10101 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
10102 both are defined.
10103
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010104 Examples :
10105 # Original Destination address
10106 frontend www
10107 mode http
10108 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
10109
10110 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
10111 backend www
10112 mode http
10113 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
10114
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010115 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010116
10117
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010118option persist
10119no option persist
10120 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
10121 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10122 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010123 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010124
10125 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
10126 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
10127 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
10128 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
10129 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
10130 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
10131 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
10132 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
10133 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
10134 redirected to another valid server.
10135
10136 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10137 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10138
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +010010139 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010140
10141
Christopher Faulet59307b32022-10-03 15:00:59 +020010142option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +010010143 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
10144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10145 yes | no | yes | yes
10146 Arguments :
10147 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
10148 PostgreSQL server.
10149
10150 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
10151 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
10152 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
10153 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
10154
10155 See also: "option httpchk"
10156
10157
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010158option prefer-last-server
10159no option prefer-last-server
10160 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
10161 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10162 yes | no | yes | yes
10163 Arguments : none
10164
10165 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010166 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010167 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
10168 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010169 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010170 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010171 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010172 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
10173 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010174 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010175 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +020010176 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
10177 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
10178 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010179 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
10180 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
10181 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010182
10183 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10184 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10185
10186 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
10187
10188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010189option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010190option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010191no option redispatch
10192 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
10193 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10194 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010195 Arguments :
10196 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
10197 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
10198 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010199 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010200 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010201 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010202 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
10203 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
10204 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
10205
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010206
10207 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
10208 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
10209 be able to access the service anymore.
10210
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +010010211 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
10212 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010213
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +020010214 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
10215 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
10216 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
10217 following order:
10218
10219 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
10220
10221 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
10222 list, or
10223
10224 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
10225
10226 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
10227 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
10228
10229 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
10230 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
10231 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
10232 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
10233
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010234 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010235 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
10236 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010237
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010238 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10239 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10240
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010241 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010242
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010243
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010244option redis-check
10245 Use redis health checks for server testing
10246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10247 yes | no | yes | yes
10248 Arguments : none
10249
10250 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
10251 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10252 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
10253 find the "+PONG" response message.
10254
10255 Example :
10256 option redis-check
10257
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010258 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010259
10260
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010261option smtpchk
10262option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
10263 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
10264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10265 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010266 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010267 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +020010268 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010269 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
10270
10271 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
10272 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
10273 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
10274
10275 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
10276 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
10277 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
10278 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
10279 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
10280 dead server.
10281
10282 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
10283 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010284 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010285 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
10286
10287 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
10288 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
10289 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10290 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010291 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010292
10293 Example :
10294 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
10295
10296 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
10297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010299option socket-stats
10300no option socket-stats
10301
10302 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
10303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10304 yes | yes | yes | no
10305
10306 Arguments : none
10307
10308
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010309option splice-auto
10310no option splice-auto
10311 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
10312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10313 yes | yes | yes | yes
10314 Arguments : none
10315
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010316 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010317 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010318 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010319 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010320 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010321 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
10322 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
10323 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
10324 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10325
10326 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
10327 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
10328 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
10329 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
10330 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
10331 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
10332 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
10333 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
10334 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
10335 keyword.
10336
10337 Example :
10338 option splice-auto
10339
10340 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10341 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10342
10343 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
10344 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10345
10346
10347option splice-request
10348no option splice-request
10349 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
10350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10351 yes | yes | yes | yes
10352 Arguments : none
10353
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010354 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010355 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010356 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10357 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10358 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10359 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10360
10361 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10362
10363 Example :
10364 option splice-request
10365
10366 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10367 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10368
10369 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
10370 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10371
10372
10373option splice-response
10374no option splice-response
10375 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
10376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10377 yes | yes | yes | yes
10378 Arguments : none
10379
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010380 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010381 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010382 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10383 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10384 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10385 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10386
10387 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10388
10389 Example :
10390 option splice-response
10391
10392 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10393 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10394
10395 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
10396 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10397
10398
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010399option spop-check
10400 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
10401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +010010402 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010403 Arguments : none
10404
10405 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
10406 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10407 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
10408 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
10409
10410 Example :
10411 option spop-check
10412
10413 See also : "option httpchk"
10414
10415
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010416option srvtcpka
10417no option srvtcpka
10418 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
10419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10420 yes | no | yes | yes
10421 Arguments : none
10422
10423 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10424 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010425 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010426 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10427
10428 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10429 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10430 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10431 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10432
10433 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10434 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10435 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10436 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10437 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10438
10439 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10440
10441 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10442 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10443 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10444
10445 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10446 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10447
10448 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10449
10450
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010451option ssl-hello-chk
10452 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10454 yes | no | yes | yes
10455 Arguments : none
10456
10457 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10458 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10459 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10460 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10461 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10462 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10463 hello message.
10464
10465 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10466 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10467 messages, which is appreciable.
10468
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010469 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010470 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10471 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010472
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010473 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10474
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010475
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010476option tcp-check
10477 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10478 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10479 yes | no | yes | yes
10480
10481 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10482 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10483
10484 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10485 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10486 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10487
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010488 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010489 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10490 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10491 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10492 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10493 only.
10494
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010495 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010496 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010497 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10498 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10499 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10500
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010501 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010502 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10503 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010504 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010505 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10506 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10507 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10508 the respective protocols.
10509 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010510 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010511
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010512 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010513
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010514 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10515 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10516 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10517 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010518
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010519 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
10520 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
10521 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010522
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010523
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010524 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010525 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010526 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010527 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010528
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010529 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010530 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010531 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010532
10533 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
10534 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010535 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010536 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010537 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010538 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010539 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010540 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010541 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10542 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010543 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010544 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10545 tcp-check expect string +OK
10546
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010547 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010548 (send many headers before analyzing)
10549 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010550 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010551 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
10552 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
10553 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
10554 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010555 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010556
10557
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010558 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010559
10560
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010561option tcp-smart-accept
10562no option tcp-smart-accept
10563 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
10564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10565 yes | yes | yes | no
10566 Arguments : none
10567
10568 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
10569 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
10570 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
10571 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
10572 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
10573 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
10574
10575 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
10576 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
10577 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
10578 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
10579
10580 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
10581 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
10582 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010583 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010584
10585 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
10586 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
10587 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
10588
10589 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
10590 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
10591 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
10592
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020010593 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
10594
10595
10596option tcp-smart-connect
10597no option tcp-smart-connect
10598 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
10599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10600 yes | no | yes | yes
10601 Arguments : none
10602
10603 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
10604 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
10605 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
10606 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
10607 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
10608
10609 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
10610 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
10611 complex.
10612
10613 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
10614 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
10615 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
10616
10617 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10618 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10619
10620 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
10621
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010622
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010623option tcpka
10624 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
10625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10626 yes | yes | yes | yes
10627 Arguments : none
10628
10629 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10630 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010631 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010632 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10633
10634 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10635 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10636 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10637 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10638
10639 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10640 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10641 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10642 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10643 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10644
10645 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10646
10647 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
10648 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
10649 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
10650 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
10651 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
10652 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
10653 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
10654 backends.
10655
10656 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
10657
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010658
10659option tcplog
10660 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
10661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010662 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010663 Arguments : none
10664
10665 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10666 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10667 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
10668 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
10669 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
10670 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
10671 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
10672 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
10673
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010674 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010676 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010677
10678
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010679option transparent
10680no option transparent
10681 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010683 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010684 Arguments : none
10685
10686 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
10687 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10688 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10689 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10690 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10691 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10692 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10693 appropriate server.
10694
10695 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10696 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10697
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010010698 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010699 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010700
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010701
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010702external-check command <command>
10703 Executable to run when performing an external-check
10704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10705 yes | no | yes | yes
10706
10707 Arguments :
10708 <command> is the external command to run
10709
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010710 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
10711
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010712 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010713
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010714 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
10715 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
10716 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
10717 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
10718 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
10719 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010720
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010721 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
10722
10723 Environment variables :
10724 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
10725 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
10726
10727 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
10728
10729 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
10730
10731 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
10732 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
10733 for a UNIX socket).
10734
10735 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
10736
10737 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
10738
10739 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
10740
10741 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
10742
10743 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10744
10745 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10746 socket).
10747
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020010748 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
10749
10750 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
10751 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
10752 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
10753 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
10754 TCP server).
10755
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010756 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10757 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10758
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010759 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10760
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010761 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10762 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10763 failed.
10764
10765 Example :
10766 external-check command /bin/true
10767
10768 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10769
10770
10771external-check path <path>
10772 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10774 yes | no | yes | yes
10775
10776 Arguments :
10777 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10778
10779 The default path is "".
10780
10781 Example :
10782 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10783
10784 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10785 "external-check command"
10786
10787
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010788persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010789persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010790 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10792 yes | no | yes | yes
10793 Arguments :
10794 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010795 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10796 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010797
10798 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10799 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010800 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010801 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10802 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10803 forwarded to this server.
10804
10805 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10806 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10807 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010808 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010809 a single "listen" section.
10810
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010811 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10812 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10813 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10814
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010815 Example :
10816 listen tse-farm
10817 bind :3389
10818 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10819 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10820 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10821 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10822 persist rdp-cookie
10823 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010824 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010825 balance rdp-cookie
10826 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10827 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10828
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010829 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010830
10831
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010832rate-limit sessions <rate>
10833 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10835 yes | yes | yes | no
10836 Arguments :
10837 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10838 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10839
10840 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10841 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10842 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010843 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010844 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10845 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10846
10847 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10848 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10849 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10850 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10851
10852 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10853 listen smtp
10854 mode tcp
10855 bind :25
10856 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010857 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010858
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010859 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10860 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10861 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010862
10863 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10864
10865
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010866redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10867redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10868redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010869 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10871 no | yes | yes | yes
10872
10873 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010874 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010875
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010876 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010877 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010878 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10879 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10880 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010881
10882 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10883 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10884 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10885 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10886 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010887 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10888 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10889 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10890 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010891
10892 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10893 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10894 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10895 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10896 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10897 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010898 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010899 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010900 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10901 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10902 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010903
10904 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010905 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10906 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10907 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010908 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010909 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10910 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10911 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10912 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010913
10914 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010915 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010916
10917 - "drop-query"
10918 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10919 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10920 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10921 with a location-type redirect.
10922
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010923 - "append-slash"
10924 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10925 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10926 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10927 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10928
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010929 - "ignore-empty"
10930 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10931 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10932 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10933 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10934 of known paths using a simple map.
10935
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010936 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10937 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10938 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10939 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10940 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10941 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10942 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10943
10944 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10945 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10946 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10947 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10948 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10949 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10950 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010951
10952 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10953 acl clear dst_port 80
10954 acl secure dst_port 8080
10955 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010956 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010957 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010958 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10959
10960 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010961 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10962 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10963 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010964 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010965
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010966 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10967 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10968 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10969
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010970 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010971 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010972
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010973 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010974 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10975 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10976 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010977
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010978 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10979 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10980 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010982 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010983
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010984
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010985retries <value>
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010986 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10988 yes | no | yes | yes
10989 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010990 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
10991 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010992
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010993 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
10994 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
10995 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
10996 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
10997 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010998
10999 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070011000 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011001 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011002
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011003 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
11004 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
11005 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011006
11007 See also : "option redispatch"
11008
11009
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011010retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020011011 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
11012 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
11013 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011014 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11015 yes | no | yes | yes
11016 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011017 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
11018 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
11019 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
11020 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
11021 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011022
11023 none never retry
11024
11025 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
11026 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
11027
11028 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
11029 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
11030 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
11031 request timeout on the server side, poor network
11032 condition, or a server crash or restart while
11033 processing the request.
11034
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020011035 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
11036 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
11037 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
11038 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
11039 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
11040 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
11041 overflow attack for example).
11042
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011043 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
11044 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
11045 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
11046 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
11047 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
11048 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
11049 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
11050 amplify denial of service attacks.
11051
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020011052 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
11053 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
11054 considered to be safe to retry.
11055
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010011056 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
11057 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
11058 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
11059 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
11060 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011061
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011062 all-retryable-errors
11063 retry request for any error that are considered
11064 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
11065 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
11066 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
11067
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011068 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
11069 not cumulative.
11070
11071 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
11072 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
11073 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
11074 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
11075
11076 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
11077 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
11078 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
11079 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
11080 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
11081 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
11082 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
11083 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
11084 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
11085 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
11086 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
11087 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
11088
11089 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
11090 should not use this directive.
11091
11092 The default is "conn-failure".
11093
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011094 Example:
11095 retry-on 503 504
11096
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011097 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
11098
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011099server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011100 Declare a server in a backend
11101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11102 no | no | yes | yes
11103 Arguments :
11104 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011105 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011106 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011107
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011108 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
11109 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
11110 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
11111 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011112 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
11113 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011114 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011115 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
11116 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011117 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
11118 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
11119 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
11120 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
11121 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11122 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11123 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011124 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020011125 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
11126 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
11127 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
11128 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
11129 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
11130 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011131 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11132 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011133 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
11134 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011135
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011136 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011137 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
11138 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
11139 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
11140 adding this value to the client's port.
11141
11142 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
11143 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011144 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011145
11146 Examples :
11147 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
11148 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011149 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011150 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
11151 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
11152 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011153
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020011154 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
11155 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
11156 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
11157 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
11158 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
11159
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011160 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
11161 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011162
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011163server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011164 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011165 this backend.
11166 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11167 no | no | yes | yes
11168
11169 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
11170 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
11171 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
11172 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
11173 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011174
11175 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
11176 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
11177
11178 global
11179 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
11180
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010011181 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011182 load-server-state-from-file
11183
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011184 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011185 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011186
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020011187server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
11188 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
11189 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
11190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11191 no | no | yes | yes
11192
11193 Arguments:
11194 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
11195
11196 <num | range>
11197 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
11198 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
11199 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
11200 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
11201
11202 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
11203
11204 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
11205
11206 <params*>
11207 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
11208 keyword.
11209
11210 Examples:
11211 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
11212 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
11213 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
11214
11215 # or
11216 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
11217
11218 # would be equivalent to:
11219 server srv1 google.com:80 check
11220 server srv2 google.com:80 check
11221 server srv3 google.com:80 check
11222
11223
11224
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011225source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011226source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011227source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011228 Set the source address for outgoing connections
11229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11230 yes | no | yes | yes
11231 Arguments :
11232 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
11233 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011234
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011235 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011236 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
11237 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
11238 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
11239 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
11240 supported prefixes are :
11241 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11242 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11243 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011244 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011245 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11246 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011247
11248 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
11249 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011250 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
11251 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
11252 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011253
11254 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
11255 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
11256 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
11257 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
11258 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
11259 <addr>.
11260
11261 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
11262 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
11263 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
11264 port.
11265
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011266 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
11267 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
11268 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
11269 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010011270 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011271 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
11272 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
11273 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
11274 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
11275 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
11276 HTTP header.
11277
11278 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
11279 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011280 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011281 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
11282 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11283 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
11284 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
11285 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
11286 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
11287 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
11288
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011289 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
11290 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
11291 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
11292 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
11293 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
11294 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
11295
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011296 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
11297 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
11298 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
11299 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
11300
11301 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
11302 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
11303 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
11304 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
11305 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
11306 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
11307
11308 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
11309 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
11310 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
11311 there are two methods :
11312
11313 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
11314 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
11315 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
11316 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
11317 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
11318 of the client ranges may be used.
11319
11320 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
11321 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
11322 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
11323 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
11324 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
11325 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
11326 same session.
11327
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011328 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
11329 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
11330 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011331 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011332
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020011333 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
11334
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011335 Examples :
11336 backend private
11337 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
11338 source 192.168.1.200
11339
11340 backend transparent_ssl1
11341 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
11342 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11343
11344 backend transparent_ssl2
11345 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
11346 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
11347 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
11348
11349 backend transparent_ssl3
11350 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
11351 # is more conntrack-friendly.
11352 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11353
11354 backend transparent_smtp
11355 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
11356 # with Tproxy version 4.
11357 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
11358
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011359 backend transparent_http
11360 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
11361 # proxy.
11362 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
11363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011364 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011365 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
11366
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011367
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011368srvtcpka-cnt <count>
11369 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
11370 the connection on the server side.
11371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11372 yes | no | yes | yes
11373 Arguments :
11374 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
11375
11376 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
11377 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011378 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11379 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011380
11381 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11382
11383
11384srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
11385 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
11386 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
11387 server side.
11388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11389 yes | no | yes | yes
11390 Arguments :
11391 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
11392 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
11393 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
11394 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
11395
11396 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
11397 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011398 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11399 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011400
11401 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11402
11403
11404srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
11405 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
11406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11407 yes | no | yes | yes
11408 Arguments :
11409 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
11410 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
11411 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
11412 document.
11413
11414 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
11415 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011416 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11417 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011418
11419 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
11420
11421
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011422stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
11423 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
11424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011425 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011426
11427 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
11428 matched.
11429
11430 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
11431 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
11432
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010011433 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
11434 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
11435 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
11436 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011437
11438 Example :
11439 # statistics admin level only for localhost
11440 backend stats_localhost
11441 stats enable
11442 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11443
11444 Example :
11445 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11446 backend stats_auth
11447 stats enable
11448 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11449 stats admin if TRUE
11450
11451 Example :
11452 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11453 userlist stats-auth
11454 group admin users admin
11455 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11456 group readonly users haproxy
11457 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11458
11459 backend stats_auth
11460 stats enable
11461 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11462 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11463 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11464 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11465
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011466 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11467 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011468
11469
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011470stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11471 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011473 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011474 Arguments :
11475 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11476
11477 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11478
11479 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11480 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11481 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11482 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11483 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11484 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11485
11486 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11487 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11488 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011489 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011490
11491 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11492 report using "stats scope".
11493
11494 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11495 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11496 unobvious parameters.
11497
11498 Example :
11499 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11500 backend public_www
11501 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11502 stats enable
11503 stats hide-version
11504 stats scope .
11505 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011506 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011507 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11508 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11509
11510 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11511 backend private_monitoring
11512 stats enable
11513 stats uri /admin?stats
11514 stats refresh 5s
11515
11516 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11517
11518
11519stats enable
11520 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
11521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011522 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011523 Arguments : none
11524
11525 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
11526 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
11527 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
11528 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
11529 - stats auth : no authentication
11530 - stats scope : no restriction
11531
11532 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11533 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11534 unobvious parameters.
11535
11536 Example :
11537 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11538 backend public_www
11539 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11540 stats enable
11541 stats hide-version
11542 stats scope .
11543 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011544 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011545 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11546 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11547
11548 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11549 backend private_monitoring
11550 stats enable
11551 stats uri /admin?stats
11552 stats refresh 5s
11553
11554 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11555
11556
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011557stats hide-version
11558 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011560 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011561 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011562
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011563 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
11564 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
11565 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
11566 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
11567 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
11568 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011569
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011570 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11571 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11572 unobvious parameters.
11573
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011574 Example :
11575 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11576 backend public_www
11577 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011578 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011579 stats hide-version
11580 stats scope .
11581 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011582 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011583 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11584 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011585
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011586 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11587 backend private_monitoring
11588 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011589 stats uri /admin?stats
11590 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010011591
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011592 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011593
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011594
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020011595stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
11596 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
11597 Access control for statistics
11598
11599 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11600 no | no | yes | yes
11601
11602 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
11603 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
11604 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
11605 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
11606 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
11607 should be asked to enter a username and password.
11608
11609 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
11610 instance.
11611
11612 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
11613 about ACL usage.
11614
11615
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011616stats realm <realm>
11617 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
11618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011619 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011620 Arguments :
11621 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
11622 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
11623 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
11624
11625 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
11626 using a backslash ('\').
11627
11628 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
11629 only related to authentication.
11630
11631 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11632 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11633 unobvious parameters.
11634
11635 Example :
11636 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11637 backend public_www
11638 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11639 stats enable
11640 stats hide-version
11641 stats scope .
11642 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011643 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011644 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11645 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11646
11647 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11648 backend private_monitoring
11649 stats enable
11650 stats uri /admin?stats
11651 stats refresh 5s
11652
11653 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
11654
11655
11656stats refresh <delay>
11657 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
11658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011659 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011660 Arguments :
11661 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
11662 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
11663 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
11664 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
11665 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
11666 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
11667
11668 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
11669 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
11670 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050011671 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011672
11673 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11674 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11675 unobvious parameters.
11676
11677 Example :
11678 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11679 backend public_www
11680 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11681 stats enable
11682 stats hide-version
11683 stats scope .
11684 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011685 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011686 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11687 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11688
11689 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11690 backend private_monitoring
11691 stats enable
11692 stats uri /admin?stats
11693 stats refresh 5s
11694
11695 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11696
11697
11698stats scope { <name> | "." }
11699 Enable statistics and limit access scope
11700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011701 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011702 Arguments :
11703 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
11704 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
11705 section in which the statement appears.
11706
11707 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
11708 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
11709 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
11710 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
11711 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
11712 exists.
11713
11714 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11715 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11716 unobvious parameters.
11717
11718 Example :
11719 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11720 backend public_www
11721 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11722 stats enable
11723 stats hide-version
11724 stats scope .
11725 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011726 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011727 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11728 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11729
11730 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11731 backend private_monitoring
11732 stats enable
11733 stats uri /admin?stats
11734 stats refresh 5s
11735
11736 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11737
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011738
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011739stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011740 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
11741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011742 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011743
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011744 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011745 description from global section is automatically used instead.
11746
11747 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11748 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
11749
11750 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11751 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011752 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011753
11754 Example :
11755 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11756 backend private_monitoring
11757 stats enable
11758 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11759 stats uri /admin?stats
11760 stats refresh 5s
11761
11762 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11763 global section.
11764
11765
11766stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011767 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11769 yes | yes | yes | yes
11770 Arguments : none
11771
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011772 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011773 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11774 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11775 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11776 - IP (socket, server)
11777 - cookie (backend, server)
11778
11779 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11780 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011781 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011782
11783 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11784
11785
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011786stats show-modules
11787 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11789 yes | yes | yes | yes
11790 Arguments : none
11791
11792 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11793 values as a tooltip.
11794
11795 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11796 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11797 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11798
11799 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11800
11801
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011802stats show-node [ <name> ]
11803 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011805 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011806 Arguments:
11807 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11808 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11809
11810 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11811 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011812 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011813
11814 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11815 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11816 unobvious parameters.
11817
11818 Example:
11819 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11820 backend private_monitoring
11821 stats enable
11822 stats show-node Europe-1
11823 stats uri /admin?stats
11824 stats refresh 5s
11825
11826 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11827 section.
11828
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011829
11830stats uri <prefix>
11831 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011833 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011834 Arguments :
11835 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11836 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11837 query string.
11838
11839 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11840 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11841 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11842 possible to reach it in the application.
11843
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011844 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011845 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011846 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11847 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11848 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11849 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11850
11851 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11852 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11853 an address or a port to statistics only.
11854
11855 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11856 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11857 unobvious parameters.
11858
11859 Example :
11860 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11861 backend public_www
11862 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11863 stats enable
11864 stats hide-version
11865 stats scope .
11866 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011867 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011868 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11869 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11870
11871 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11872 backend private_monitoring
11873 stats enable
11874 stats uri /admin?stats
11875 stats refresh 5s
11876
11877 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11878
11879
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011880stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11881 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011883 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011884
11885 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011886 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011887 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011888 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011889 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11890
11891 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11892 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11893 the "stick-table" statement.
11894
11895 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11896 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11897 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11898 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11899 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11900
11901 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11902 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11903 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11904 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11905 transformation rules.
11906
11907 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11908 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11909 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11910 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11911 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11912 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11913 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11914
11915 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11916 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11917 ACL based conditions.
11918
11919 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11920 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11921 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11922 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11923
11924 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11925 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11926 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11927 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11928
11929 Example :
11930 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11931 # last 30 minutes
11932 backend pop
11933 mode tcp
11934 balance roundrobin
11935 stick store-request src
11936 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11937 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11938 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11939
11940 backend smtp
11941 mode tcp
11942 balance roundrobin
11943 stick match src table pop
11944 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11945 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11946
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011947 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11948 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011949
11950
11951stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11952 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11954 no | no | yes | yes
11955
11956 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11957 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11958 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11959 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11960
11961 Examples :
11962 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011963 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011964
11965 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11966 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11967 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11968
11969
11970 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11971 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11972 backend http
11973 mode http
11974 balance roundrobin
11975 stick on src table https
11976 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11977 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11978 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11979
11980 backend https
11981 mode tcp
11982 balance roundrobin
11983 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11984 stick on src
11985 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11986 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11987
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011988 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011989
11990
11991stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11992 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11994 no | no | yes | yes
11995
11996 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011997 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011998 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011999 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012000 server is selected.
12001
12002 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12003 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12004 the "stick-table" statement.
12005
12006 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12007 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12008 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
12009 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
12010 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
12011 address.
12012
12013 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12014 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
12015 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
12016 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
12017 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
12018 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
12019 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
12020 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
12021 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
12022 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
12023
12024 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12025 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12026 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12027 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12028 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12029 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12030 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12031
12032 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
12033 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12034 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
12035 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12036
12037 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
12038 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12039 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12040 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12041 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12042 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012043 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
12044 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12045 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12046 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12047 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12048 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012049
12050 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
12051 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
12052 the request.
12053
12054 Example :
12055 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12056 # last 30 minutes
12057 backend pop
12058 mode tcp
12059 balance roundrobin
12060 stick store-request src
12061 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12062 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12063 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12064
12065 backend smtp
12066 mode tcp
12067 balance roundrobin
12068 stick match src table pop
12069 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12070 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12071
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012072 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012073
12074
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012075stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012076 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012077 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080012078 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012080 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012081
12082 Arguments :
12083 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
12084 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
12085 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12086 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12087
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010012088 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
12089 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
12090 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12091 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12092
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012093 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
12094 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
12095 instance.
12096
12097 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
12098 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
12099 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
12100 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
12101 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
12102 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012103 to 32 characters.
12104
12105 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
12106 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
12107 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012108 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012109 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
12110 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012111
12112 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012113 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
12114 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012115 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
12116 increase.
12117
12118 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012119 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
12120 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
12121 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012122
12123 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012124 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012125 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
12126 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012127 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012128 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
12129 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
12130 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
12131 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
12132 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
12133 parameter (see below).
12134
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012135 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
12136 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
12137 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
12138 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
12139 soft restart.
12140
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012141 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012142 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
12143 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012144 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
12145 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012146 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012147 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012148 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
12149 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012150 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
12151 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012152
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012153 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
12154 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
12155 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
12156 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
12157 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
12158 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
12159 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
12160 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
12161 token.
12162
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012163 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
12164 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
12165 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
12166 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012167 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
12168 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
12169 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
12170 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
12171 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
12172 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
12173 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
12174 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
12175 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
12176 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
12177 types and their arguments.
12178
12179 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
12180 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
12181 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
12182 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
12183
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012184 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
12185 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
12186 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
12187 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
12188 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
12189 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
12190 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
12191 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
12192 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
12193 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012194 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
12195 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
12196 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
12197 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012198
12199 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
12200 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
12201 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
12202 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
12203 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
12204 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012205 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
12206 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
12207 update message can fit into the buffer.
12208 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
12209 store only the counter gpc0.
12210 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012211 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
12212 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
12213 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012214 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
12215 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
12216 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
12217 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012218
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012219 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12220 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12221 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012222 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012223
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012224 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12225 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12226 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012227 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012228 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012229 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012230
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012231 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12232 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12233 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12234 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
12235
12236 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
12237 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12238 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
12239 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
12240 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
12241 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
12242
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012243 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
12244 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
12245 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
12246 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
12247 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012248 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
12249 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
12250 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
12251 to store only the tag gpt0.
12252 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
12253 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
12254 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020012255 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
12256 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
12257 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012258
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020012259 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12260 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12261 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12262 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
12263
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012264 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12265 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
12266 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
12267 they were received.
12268
12269 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12270 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
12271 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
12272 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
12273 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
12274
12275 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12276 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12277 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12278 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
12279 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12280
12281 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12282 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
12283 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
12284
12285 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12286 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12287 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12288 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
12289 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12290
12291 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12292 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
12293 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
12294 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
12295 the client side.
12296
12297 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12298 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12299 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12300 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
12301 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
12302 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
12303 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
12304
12305 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12306 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
12307 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12308 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
12309 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
12310 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012311 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012312
12313 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12314 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12315 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12316 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12317 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
12318 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12319
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010012320 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12321 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
12322 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12323 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
12324 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
12325
12326 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12327 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12328 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12329 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12330 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
12331 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12332
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012333 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012334 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012335 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
12336 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
12337
12338 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12339 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12340 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12341 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12342 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12343 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
12344 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
12345 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
12346 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
12347 recommended for better fairness.
12348
12349 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012350 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012351 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
12352 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
12353
12354 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12355 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12356 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12357 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12358 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12359 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
12360 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
12361 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
12362 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
12363 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012364
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012365 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
12366 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012367 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
12368 reference it.
12369
12370 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
12371 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010012372 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
12373 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
12374 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012375
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012376 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
12377 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
12378 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
12379 something that can be ignored.
12380
12381 Example:
12382 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
12383 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
12384 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
12385 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
12386
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012387 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010012388 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012389
12390
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012391stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010012392 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12394 no | no | yes | yes
12395
12396 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012397 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012398 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012399 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012400 server is selected.
12401
12402 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12403 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12404 the "stick-table" statement.
12405
12406 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12407 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12408 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
12409 when the response is a SSL server hello.
12410
12411 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12412 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
12413 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
12414 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
12415 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
12416 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012417 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012418 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
12419 rules.
12420
12421 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12422 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12423 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12424 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12425 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12426 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12427 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12428
12429 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
12430 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12431 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
12432 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12433
12434 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
12435 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12436 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12437 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12438 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12439 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012440 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
12441 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12442 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12443 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12444 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12445 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12446 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12447 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12448 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012449
12450 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12451
12452 Example :
12453 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12454 backend https
12455 mode tcp
12456 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012457 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012458 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012459
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012460 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
12461 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012462
12463 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12464 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12465 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12466
12467 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12468 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012469
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012470 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12471 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12472 # at offset 44.
12473
12474 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012475 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012476
12477 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012478 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012479
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012480 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12481 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12482
12483 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12484 extraction.
12485
12486
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012487tcp-check comment <string>
12488 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12489 it fails.
12490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12491 yes | no | yes | yes
12492
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012493 Arguments :
12494 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12495 rule fails.
12496
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012497 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12498 user-friendly error reporting.
12499
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012500 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12501 "tcp-check expect".
12502
12503
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012504tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12505 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012506 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012507 Opens a new connection
12508 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012509 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012510
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012511 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012512 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12513
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012514 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012515 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012516
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012517 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012518 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
12519 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012520 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012521
12522 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012523
12524 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
12525
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020012526 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
12527
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012528 ssl opens a ciphered connection
12529
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020012530 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
12531
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020012532 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
12533 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
12534 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12535 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12536
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012537 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
12538 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
12539 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
12540 haproxy -vv.
12541
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012542 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012543
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012544 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
12545 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
12546 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
12547
12548 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
12549 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
12550 of the sequence.
12551
12552 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
12553 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
12554 do.
12555
12556 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
12557 unset-var or comment rules.
12558
12559 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012560 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
12561 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
12562 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
12563 option tcp-check
12564 tcp-check connect
12565 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12566 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12567 tcp-check send \r\n
12568 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12569 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
12570 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12571 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12572 tcp-check send \r\n
12573 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12574 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
12575
12576 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
12577 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012578 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012579 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12580 tcp-check connect port 143
12581 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12582 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
12583
12584 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
12585
12586
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012587tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012588 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012589 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012590 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012591 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012593 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012594
12595 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012596 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12597
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012598 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
12599 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
12600 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
12601 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
12602 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
12603 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
12604 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
12605 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
12606 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
12607 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
12608
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012609 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012610 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
12611 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012612 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
12613 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
12614 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
12615
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012616 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12617 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
12618 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012619 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
12620 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012621 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12622 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012623 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
12624 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012625 By default "L7OK" is used.
12626
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012627 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12628 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012629 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
12630 supported :
12631 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12632 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012633 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12634 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
12635 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12636 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
12637 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012638
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012639 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012640 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012641 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
12642 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12643 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12644 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012645 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
12646
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020012647 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12648 informational message reported in logs if the expect
12649 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
12650 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
12651
12652 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12653 informational message reported in logs if an error
12654 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
12655 log-format string.
12656
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012657 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
12658 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
12659 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12660 followed by some converters.
12661
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012662 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
12663 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
12664 with the usual backslash ('\').
12665 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012666 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012667 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
12668 used upper or lower case.
12669
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012670 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
12671
12672 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
12673 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12674 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
12675 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12676 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
12677 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
12678 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
12679 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
12680
12681 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
12682 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12683 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
12684 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12685 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
12686 expression.
12687
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012688 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
12689 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12690 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
12691 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
12692 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12693 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
12694
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012695 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
12696 in the response buffer. A health check response will
12697 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
12698 this exact hexadecimal string.
12699 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
12700
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012701 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
12702 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
12703 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
12704 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
12705 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
12706 size of the original response. As such, the expected
12707 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
12708 size.
12709
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012710 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
12711 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
12712 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
12713 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
12714 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
12715 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12716 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
12717 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
12718 in a binary string before matching the response's
12719 buffer.
12720
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012721 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012722 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012723 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
12724 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
12725 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
12726 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
12727 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
12728 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
12729 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
12730 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
12731 the null character.
12732
12733 Examples :
12734 # perform a POP check
12735 option tcp-check
12736 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12737
12738 # perform an IMAP check
12739 option tcp-check
12740 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12741
12742 # look for the redis master server
12743 option tcp-check
12744 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020012745 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012746 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12747 tcp-check expect string role:master
12748 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
12749 tcp-check expect string +OK
12750
12751
12752 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012753 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012754
12755
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012756tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
12757tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
12758 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
12759 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012761 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012762
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012763 Arguments :
12764 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12765
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012766 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
12767 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012768
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012769 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
12770 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012771
12772 Examples :
12773 # look for the redis master server
12774 option tcp-check
12775 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12776 tcp-check expect string role:master
12777
12778 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012779 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012780
12781
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012782tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
12783tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
12784 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
12785 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012786 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012787 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012788
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012789 Arguments :
12790 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012791
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012792 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12793 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012794
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012795 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12796 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12797 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012798
12799 Examples :
12800 # redis check in binary
12801 option tcp-check
12802 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12803 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12804
12805
12806 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012807 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012808
12809
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012810tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12811tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012812 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012813 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012814 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012815
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012816 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012817 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12818 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12819 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12820 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12821 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12822 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12823 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12824 and '-'.
12825
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012826 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
12827 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050012828 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012829 conditions.
12830
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012831 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12832
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012833 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12834 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12835
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012836 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012837 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012838 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012839
12840
12841tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012842 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012844 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012845
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012846 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012847 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12848 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12849 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12850 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12851 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12852 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12853 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12854 and '-'.
12855
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012856 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012857 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12858
12859
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012860tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012861 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012863 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012864 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012865 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12866 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012867
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012868 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012869
12870 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12871 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012872 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12873 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12874 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12875 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12876 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12877 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012878
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012879 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12880 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12881 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012882 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12883 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12884 is true.
12885
12886 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12887 supported:
12888 - accept
12889 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12890 - expect-proxy layer4
12891 - reject
12892 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12893 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12894 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12895 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12896 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12897 - set-dst <expr>
12898 - set-dst-port <expr>
12899 - set-mark <mark>
12900 - set-src <expr>
12901 - set-src-port <expr>
12902 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012903 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12904 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010012905 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012906 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12907 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12908 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012909 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012910
12911 The supported actions are described below.
12912
12913 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12914 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012915
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012916 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12917 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12918 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12919 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12920 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12921 a defaults section defining such rules.
12922
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012923 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12924 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12925 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012926
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012927 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12928 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12929 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012930
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012931 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12932 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12933 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012934
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012935 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12936 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12937 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012938
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012939 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12940 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12941 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012942
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012943 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012944
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012945 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012946
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012947 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012948
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012949 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012950
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012951tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012952
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012953 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12954 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012955
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012956tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12957 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012958
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012959 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
12960 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
12961 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
12962 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
12963 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
12964 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12965 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012966
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012967tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012968
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012969 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12970 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
12971 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
12972 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
12973 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
12974 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012975
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012976tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012977
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012978 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12979 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
12980 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
12981 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
12982 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
12983 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
12984 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
12985 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
12986 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
12987 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
12988 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012989
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012990tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12991tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12992tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012993
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012994 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12995 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12996 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12997 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012998
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012999tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13000 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13001tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13002 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013003
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013004 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13005 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13006 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013007
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013008tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13009tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013010
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013011 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13012 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13013 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013014
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013015tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013016
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013017 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13018 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13019 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013020
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013021tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13022tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013023
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013024 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13025 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13026 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013027
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013028tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013029
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013030 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13031 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13032 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013033
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013034tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13035tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013036
13037 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13038 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
13039 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13040 for a complete description.
13041
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013042tcp-request connection silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013043
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013044 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13045 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13046 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13047 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013048
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013049tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13050tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13051tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013052
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013053 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13054 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13055 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013056
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013057tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13058
13059 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13060 details about variables.
13061
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013063tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13064 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013066 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013067 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013068 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13069 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013070
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013071 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013072
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013073 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013074 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13075 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013076 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
13077 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013078
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013079 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
13080 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
13081 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
13082 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013083 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013084 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013085 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
13086 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
13087 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
13088 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013089 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013090 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013091
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013092 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13093 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13094 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13095 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013096
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013097 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13098 supported:
13099 - accept
13100 - capture <sample> len <length>
13101 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13102 - reject
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013103 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013104 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013105 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013106 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010013107 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013108 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013109 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020013110 - set-dst <expr>
13111 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013112 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013113 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013114 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013115 - set-priority-class <expr>
13116 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013117 - set-src <expr>
13118 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013119 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013120 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13121 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013122 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013123 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013124 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13125 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13126 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013127 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013128 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013129
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013130 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013131
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013132 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
13133 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
13134 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
13135 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
13136 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
13137 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013138
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013139 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13140 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13141 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13142 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13143 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13144 a defaults section defining such rules.
13145
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013146 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013147 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13148 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013149
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020013150 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
13151 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
13152 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
13153 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
13154 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
13155 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
13156
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013157 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020013158 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
13159 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
13160 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
13161 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
13162 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
13163 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
13164 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
13165 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
13166 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
13167 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013168
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013169 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013170 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
13171 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
13172 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013173
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013174 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONd49b5592022-10-05 18:09:33 +020013175 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013176
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013177 Example:
13178
13179 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013180 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013181 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013182
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013183 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013184 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013185 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013186 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13187 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020013188 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013189 tcp-request content reject
13190
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013191 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
13192 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
13193 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13194 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13195 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
13196 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
13197 ...
13198 http-request reject unless is_host_com
13199
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013200 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013201 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
13202 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013203 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013204 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013205
13206 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
13207 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013208 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013209 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013210 tcp-request content reject
13211
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013212 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013213 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013214 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013215 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013216 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
13217 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013218
13219 Example:
13220 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13221 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013222 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013223
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013224 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013225 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013226
13227 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013228 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013229 # protecting all our sites
13230 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013231 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13232 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013233 ...
13234 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
13235
13236 backend http_dynamic
13237 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013238 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013239 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013240 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013241 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013242 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013243 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013245 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013246
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030013247 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
13248 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013249
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013250tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13251
13252 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010013253 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013254
13255tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
13256 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13257
13258 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
13259 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
13260 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
13261 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
13262 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
13263 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
13264 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
13265 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
13266 information.
13267
13268tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13269
13270 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
13271 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
13272 complete description.
13273
13274tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13275
13276 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
13277 are evaluated.
13278
13279tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13280tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13281tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13282
13283 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13284 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13285 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13286 description.
13287
13288tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13289 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13290tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13291 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13292
13293 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13294 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13295 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
13296
13297tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13298 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13299
13300 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13301 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
13302
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013303tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13304 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013305
13306 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13307 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13308 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13309
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013310tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13311tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13312
13313 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13314 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13315 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13316
13317tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13318
13319 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13320 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
13321
13322tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13323
13324 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13325 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13326 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13327
13328tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13329
13330 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13331 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
13332
13333tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13334
13335 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
13336 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
13337
13338tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13339
13340 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
13341 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
13342 description.
13343
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013344tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13345tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13346
13347 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13348 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13349 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13350
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013351tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13352
13353 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13354 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13355 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13356
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013357tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13358tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013359
13360 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13361 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13362 for a complete description.
13363
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013364tcp-request content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013365
13366 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13367 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13368 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13369 complete description.
13370
13371tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
13372 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13373
13374 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
13375 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
13376 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
13377 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
13378 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
13379 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
13380 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
13381 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
13382 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
13383 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
13384
13385 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
13386
13387tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13388tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13389tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13390
13391 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13392 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13393 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13394
13395tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13396
13397 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13398 details about variables.
13399
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020013400tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013401
13402 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
13403 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
13404 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
13405 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
13406 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
13407
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013408
13409tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
13410 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
13411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013412 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013413 Arguments :
13414 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13415 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13416 as explained at the top of this document.
13417
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013418 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013419 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
13420 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
13421 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
13422 data for at most the specified amount of time.
13423
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020013424 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
13425 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
13426 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
13427 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
13428
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013429 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013430 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013431 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013432 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013433 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010013434 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
13435 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
13436 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013437
13438 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
13439 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
13440 it pass through unaffected.
13441
13442 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13443 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13444 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013445 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013446 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13447 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013448 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13449 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13450 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013451
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013452 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13453 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13454
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013455 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013456 "timeout client".
13457
13458
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013459tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13460 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013462 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013463 Arguments :
13464 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13465 below.
13466
13467 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13468
13469 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13470 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13471 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13472 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013473 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013474 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13475 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13476 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13477 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13478 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13479 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13480 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13481 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13482 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13483 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13484 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13485 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13486 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13487 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13488 instead.
13489
13490 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13491 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13492 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13493 rules which may be inserted.
13494
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013495 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13496 supported:
13497 - accept
13498 - reject
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013499 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13500 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13501 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13502 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13503 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013504 - set-dst <expr>
13505 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013506 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013507 - set-src <expr>
13508 - set-src-port <expr>
13509 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013510 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13511 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013512 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013513 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13514 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13515 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
13516 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013517
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013518 The supported actions are described below.
13519
13520 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13521 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13522 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13523 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13524 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13525 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013526
13527 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13528 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13529 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
13530
13531 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
13532 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
13533 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
13534 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
13535 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
13536
13537 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
13538 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13539
13540 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13541 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
13542 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
13543
13544 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13545 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
13546 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13547
13548 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
13549 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13550 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
13551
13552 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13553 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13554 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
13555
13556 See section 7 about ACL usage.
13557
13558 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
13559
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013560tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13561
13562 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
13563 rules are evaluated.
13564
13565tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13566
13567 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
13568 are evaluated.
13569
13570tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13571tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13572tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13573
13574 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13575 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13576 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13577 description.
13578
13579tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13580 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13581tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13582 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13583
13584 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13585 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
13586 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
13587 description.
13588
13589tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13590tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13591
13592 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13593 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13594 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13595
13596tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13597
13598 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13599 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13600 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13601
13602tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13603tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13604
13605 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13606 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13607 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13608
13609tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13610
13611 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13612 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13613 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13614
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013615tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13616tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013617
13618 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13619 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13620 for a complete description.
13621
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013622tcp-request session silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013623
13624 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13625 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13626 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13627 complete description.
13628
13629tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13630tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13631tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13632
13633 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13634 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13635 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13636
13637tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13638
13639 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13640 details about variables.
13641
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013642
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013643tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13644 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
13645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013646 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013647 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013648 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13649 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013650
13651 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13652
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013653 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013654 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13655 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013656 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
13657 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013658
13659 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
13660
13661 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13662 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13663 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13664 inserted.
13665
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013666 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13667 supported:
13668 - accept
13669 - close
13670 - reject
13671 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13672 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13673 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13674 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13675 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13676 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013677 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013678 - set-log-level <level>
13679 - set-mark <mark>
13680 - set-nice <nice>
13681 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013682 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13683 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013684 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013685 - unset-var(<var-name>)
13686
13687 The supported actions are described below.
13688
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013689 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13690 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13691 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13692 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13693 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13694 a defaults section defining such rules.
13695
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013696 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13697 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13698 for changing the default action to a reject.
13699
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013700 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013701
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013702 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
13703 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
13704 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
13705 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
13706 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013707
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013708 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013709
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013710 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013711
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013712tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013713
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013714 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13715 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013716
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013717tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013718
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013719 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
13720 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
13721 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
13722 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
13723 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
13724 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013725
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013726tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013727
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013728 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13729 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013730
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013731tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13732tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13733tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013734
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013735 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13736 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13737 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13738 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013739
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013740tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13741 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13742tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13743 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013744
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013745 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13746 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13747 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013748
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013749tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13750 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013751
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013752 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13753 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013754
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013755
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013756tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13757 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013758
13759 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13760 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13761 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13762
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013763tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013764
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013765 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13766 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013767
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013768tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013769
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013770 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13771 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13772 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013773
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013774tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013775
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013776 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13777 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013778
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013779tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013780
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013781 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13782 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13783 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013784
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013785tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13786tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013787
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013788 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13789 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13790 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013791
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013792tcp-response content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013793
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013794 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13795 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13796 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13797 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013798
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013799tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013800
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013801 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13802 details about variables.
13803
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013804
13805tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
13806 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
13807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013808 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013809 Arguments :
13810 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13811 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13812 as explained at the top of this document.
13813
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013814 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13815 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013816
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013817 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
13818
13819
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013820timeout check <timeout>
13821 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
13822 established.
13823
13824 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13825 yes | no | yes | yes
13826 Arguments:
13827 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13828 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13829 as explained at the top of this document.
13830
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013831 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013832 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013833 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013834 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010013835 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
13836 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
13837 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013838
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013839 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013840 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
13841
13842 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
13843 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013844 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013845
13846 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13847 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13848 forget about it.
13849
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013850 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13851 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13852
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013853 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
13854 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013855
13856
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013857timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013858 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
13859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13860 yes | yes | yes | no
13861 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013862 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013863 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13864 as explained at the top of this document.
13865
13866 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13867 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13868 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010013869 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
13870 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
13871 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
13872 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013873 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
13874 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
13875 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013876 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013877 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013878 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13879 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013880 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13881 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013882
13883 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13884 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13885 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13886 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013887 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013888 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13889
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013890 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013891
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013892
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013893timeout client-fin <timeout>
13894 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13896 yes | yes | yes | no
13897 Arguments :
13898 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13899 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13900 as explained at the top of this document.
13901
13902 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13903 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13904 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13905 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13906 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13907 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13908 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013909 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13910 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13911 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013912
13913 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13914 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13915 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13916
13917 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13918
13919
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013920timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013921 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13923 yes | no | yes | yes
13924 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013925 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013926 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13927 as explained at the top of this document.
13928
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013929 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013930 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013931 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013932 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013933 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13934 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013935
13936 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13937 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13938 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13939 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013940 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013941 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13942
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013943 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013944
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013945
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013946timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13947 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13949 yes | yes | yes | yes
13950 Arguments :
13951 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13952 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13953 as explained at the top of this document.
13954
13955 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13956 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13957 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13958 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13959 once the request has started to present itself.
13960
13961 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13962 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13963 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13964 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13965 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13966
13967 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13968 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13969 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13970 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13971
13972 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13973 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013974 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013975 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13976 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013977 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013978
13979 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13980 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13981 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13982 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13983
13984 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13985
13986
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013987timeout http-request <timeout>
13988 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013990 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013991 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013992 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013993 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13994 as explained at the top of this document.
13995
13996 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13997 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13998 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13999 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
14000 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
14001 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
14002 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014003 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
14004 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
14005 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
14006 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014007 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014008 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
14009 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014010
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014011 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
14012 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
14013 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
14014 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
14015 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014016 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014017
14018 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
14019 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014020 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014021 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
14022 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
14023
14024 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014025 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
14026 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
14027 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014028
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014029 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014030 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014031
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014032
14033timeout queue <timeout>
14034 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
14035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14036 yes | no | yes | yes
14037 Arguments :
14038 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14039 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14040 as explained at the top of this document.
14041
14042 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
14043 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
14044 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
14045 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
14046 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
14047
14048 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
14049 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
14050 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
14051 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
14052
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014053 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014054
14055
14056timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014057 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
14058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14059 yes | no | yes | yes
14060 Arguments :
14061 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14062 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14063 as explained at the top of this document.
14064
14065 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14066 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14067 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
14068 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
14069 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
14070 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
14071 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
14072
14073 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14074 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14075 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
14076 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
14077 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014078 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014079 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014080 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
14081 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014082 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
14083 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014084
14085 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14086 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14087 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14088 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014089 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014090 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14091
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014092 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014093
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014094
14095timeout server-fin <timeout>
14096 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
14097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14098 yes | no | yes | yes
14099 Arguments :
14100 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14101 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14102 as explained at the top of this document.
14103
14104 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14105 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14106 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14107 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14108 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
14109 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14110 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
14111 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
14112 situations, it should not be needed.
14113
14114 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14115 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14116 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
14117
14118 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
14119
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014120
14121timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014122 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14124 yes | yes | yes | yes
14125 Arguments :
14126 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
14127 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14128 as explained at the top of this document.
14129
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014130 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
14131 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
14132 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014133
14134 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14135 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14136 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
14137 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014138 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014139
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014140 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014141
14142
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014143timeout tunnel <timeout>
14144 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
14145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14146 yes | no | yes | yes
14147 Arguments :
14148 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14149 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14150 as explained at the top of this document.
14151
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014152 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014153 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
14154 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
14155 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014156 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
14157 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014158 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
14159 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
14160 specified.
14161
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014162 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
14163 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
14164 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
14165 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
14166 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
14167 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
14168 state.
14169
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014170 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14171 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14172 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
14173 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014174 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014175
14176 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14177 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14178 forget about it.
14179
14180 Example :
14181 defaults http
14182 option http-server-close
14183 timeout connect 5s
14184 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014185 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014186 timeout server 30s
14187 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
14188
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014189 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014190
14191
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014192transparent (deprecated)
14193 Enable client-side transparent proxying
14194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010014195 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014196 Arguments : none
14197
14198 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
14199 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
14200 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
14201 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
14202 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
14203 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
14204 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
14205 appropriate server.
14206
14207 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
14208
14209 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
14210 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
14211
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014212 See also: "option transparent"
14213
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014214unique-id-format <string>
14215 Generate a unique ID for each request.
14216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14217 yes | yes | yes | no
14218 Arguments :
14219 <string> is a log-format string.
14220
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014221 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
14222 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
14223 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
14224 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014225
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014226 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014227 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014228 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
14229 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
14230 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
14231 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
14232 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
14233 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014234
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014235 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
14236 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014237
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014238 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014239
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014240 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014241
14242 will generate:
14243
14244 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14245
14246 See also: "unique-id-header"
14247
14248unique-id-header <name>
14249 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
14250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14251 yes | yes | yes | no
14252 Arguments :
14253 <name> is the name of the header.
14254
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014255 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
14256 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014257
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014258 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014259
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014260 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014261 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
14262
14263 will generate:
14264
14265 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14266
14267 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014268
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014269use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014270 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14272 no | yes | yes | no
14273 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014274 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
14275 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014276
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014277 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
14278 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014279
14280 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
14281 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
14282 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014283 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014284 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014285 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
14286 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014287
14288 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
14289 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
14290 assign the backend.
14291
14292 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
14293 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14294 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
14295 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
14296 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
14297 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
14298
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014299 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014300 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014301 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
14302 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
14303 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
14304
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014305 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
14306 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
14307 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
14308 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
14309 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
14310 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
14311 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
14312 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
14313 cannot be forced from the request.
14314
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014315 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014316 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
14317 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
14318
14319 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
14320 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014321
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020014322use-fcgi-app <name>
14323 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
14324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14325 no | no | yes | yes
14326 Arguments :
14327 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
14328
14329 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014330
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014331use-server <server> if <condition>
14332use-server <server> unless <condition>
14333 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
14334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14335 no | no | yes | yes
14336 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014337 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
14338 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014339
14340 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
14341
14342 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
14343 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
14344 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
14345
14346 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
14347 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
14348 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
14349 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
14350 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
14351 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
14352 matches will assign the server.
14353
14354 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
14355 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
14356 with the next rules until one matches.
14357
14358 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
14359 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14360 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
14361 according to other persistence mechanisms.
14362
14363 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
14364 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
14365 stripped.
14366
14367 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
14368 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014369 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014370 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014371 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014372
14373 Example :
14374 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014375 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014376 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014377 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014378 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014379 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000014380 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014381 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
14382 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
14383
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014384 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
14385 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
14386 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
14387 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050014388 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014389 and we fall back to load balancing.
14390
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014391 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014392
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014393
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100143945. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014395--------------------------
14396
14397The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
14398depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
14399settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
14400written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
14401described in this section.
14402
14403
144045.1. Bind options
14405-----------------
14406
14407The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
14408as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
14409no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
14410parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
14411while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
14412provided immediately after the setting name.
14413
14414The currently supported settings are the following ones.
14415
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014416accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
14417 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
14418 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
14419 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
14420 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
14421 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
14422 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
14423 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
14424 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
14425 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010014426 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
14427 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
14428 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014429
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014430accept-proxy
14431 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020014432 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
14433 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014434 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
14435 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
14436 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
14437 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014438 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014439 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
14440 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020014441 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
14442 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014443
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014444allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014445 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014446 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014447 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014448 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14449 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014450
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014451alpn <protocols>
14452 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14453 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14454 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014455 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014456 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014457 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
14458 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14459 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
14460 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
14461 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
14462 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
14463 preference, like below :
14464
14465 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014466
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014467 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
14468 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
14469
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014470backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010014471 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014472 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
14473
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010014474curves <curves>
14475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14476 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
14477 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
14478 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
14479 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
14480 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
14481
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014482ecdhe <named curve>
14483 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010014484 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
14485 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014486
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014487ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14489 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014490 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14491 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014492 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014493
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014494 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
14495 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
14496 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
14497 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
14498 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050014499 extremely insecure.
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014500
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014501ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
14502 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14503 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014504 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14505 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14506 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14507 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14508 in new version of OpenSSL.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014509 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14510 error is ignored.
14511
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014512ca-sign-file <cafile>
14513 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14514 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
14515 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
14516 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14517 'generate-certificates' for details.
14518
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000014519ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014520 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
14521 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
14522 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14523 'generate-certificates' for details.
14524
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014525ca-verify-file <cafile>
14526 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
14527 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
14528 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
14529 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
14530 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
14531
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014532ciphers <ciphers>
14533 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14534 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000014535 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014536 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014537 information and recommendations see e.g.
14538 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14539 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14540 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
14541
14542ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14543 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14544 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
14545 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
14546 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014547 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
14548 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014549
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014550crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014551 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14552 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020014553 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
14554 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014555
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014556crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014557 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14558 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
14559 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
14560 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
14561 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010014562 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
14563 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014564
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010014565 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
14566 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
14567
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014568 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
14569 are loaded.
14570
14571 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010014572 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020014573 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
14574 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
14575 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
14576 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
14577 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
14578 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
14579 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
14580 www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014581
14582 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
14583 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
14584 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
14585 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010014586 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
14587 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014588
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020014589 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014590
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014591 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014592 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014593 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
14594 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014595 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
14596 clients).
14597
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014598 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014599 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
14600 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
14601 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
14602 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
14603 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
14604 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
14605 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
14606 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
14607 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
14608 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
14609 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
14610 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
14611
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014612 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010014613 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
14614 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
14615 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
14616 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
14617
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050014618 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
14619 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
14620 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
14621 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014622
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014623 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
14624 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
14625 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014626
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014627crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014628 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014629 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
14630 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14631 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14632 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14633 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14634 in new version of OpenSSL.
14635 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14636 error is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014637
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014638crt-list <file>
14639 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014640 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
14641 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014642
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014643 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
14644
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020014645 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
14646 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
14647 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
14648 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
14649 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014650
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014651 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014652 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
14653 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
14654 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
14655 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
14656 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014657 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
14658 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
14659 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014660
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014661 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
14662 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
14663 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014664
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014665 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
14666
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014667 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014668 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014669 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
14670 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
14671 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
14672 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
14673 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
14674 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014675
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014676 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014677 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014678 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014679 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014680 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014681 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014682
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014683defer-accept
14684 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14685 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
14686 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014687 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014688 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
14689 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
14690 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
14691 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
14692 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
14693 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
14694 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
14695
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014696expose-fd listeners
14697 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
14698 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010014699 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
14700 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014701 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014702
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014703force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014704 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014705 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014706 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014707 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014708
14709force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014710 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014711 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014712 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014713
14714force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014715 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014716 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014717 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014718
14719force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014720 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014721 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014722 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014723
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014724force-tlsv13
14725 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
14726 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014727 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014728
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014729generate-certificates
14730 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14731 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
14732 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
14733 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
14734 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
14735 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
14736 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
14737 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
14738 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
14739 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
14740 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
14741
14742 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
14743 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014744 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014745 certificate is used many times.
14746
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014747gid <gid>
14748 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
14749 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14750 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
14751 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
14752 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14753
14754group <group>
14755 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
14756 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
14757 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
14758 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
14759 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14760
14761id <id>
14762 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
14763 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
14764 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
14765 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
14766
14767interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010014768 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
14769 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
14770 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
14771 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
14772 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
14773 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010014774 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
14775 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
14776 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
14777 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
14778 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
14779 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014780
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014781level <level>
14782 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
14783 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
14784 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014785 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014786 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
14787 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
14788 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014789 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014790 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014791 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014792 all counters).
14793
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020014794severity-output <format>
14795 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
14796 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
14797 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
14798 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
14799 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
14800 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
14801 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
14802 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
14803 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
14804 rfc5424 convention.
14805
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014806maxconn <maxconn>
14807 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
14808 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
14809 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
14810 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
14811 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
14812 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
14813 eat all memory.
14814
14815mode <mode>
14816 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
14817 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
14818 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
14819 UNIX sockets.
14820
14821mss <maxseg>
14822 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
14823 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
14824 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
14825 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
14826 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
14827 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
14828 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
14829 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
14830 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
14831 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
14832 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
14833
14834name <name>
14835 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
14836 page.
14837
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014838namespace <name>
14839 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14840 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
14841 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14842 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14843
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014844nice <nice>
14845 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
14846 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
14847 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
14848 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
14849 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
14850 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
14851 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
14852 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
14853 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
14854 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
14855 one for an RDP socket.
14856
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014857no-ca-names
14858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14859 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014860 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014861
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014862no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014863 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014864 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014865 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014866 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014867 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
14868 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014869
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014870no-tls-tickets
14871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14872 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14873 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014874 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
14875 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014876 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14877 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14878 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014879
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014880no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014881 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014882 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014883 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014884 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014885 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14886 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014887
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014888no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014889 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014890 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014891 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014892 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014893 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14894 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014895
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014896no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014897 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014898 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014899 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014900 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014901 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14902 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014903
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014904no-tlsv13
14905 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14906 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14907 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14908 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014909 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14910 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014911
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014912npn <protocols>
14913 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14914 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14915 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014916 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014917 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014918 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14919 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14920 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14921 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14922 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014923
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010014924ocsp-update [ off | on ]
14925 Enable automatic OCSP response update when set to 'on', disable it otherwise.
14926 Its value defaults to 'off'.
14927 This option can only be used in a crt-list line so that is applies to only
14928 one certificate at a time. If a given certificate is used in multiple
14929 crt-lists with different values of the 'ocsp-update' set, an error will be
14930 raised.
14931 When the option is set to 'on', we will try to get an ocsp response whenever
14932 an ocsp uri is found in the frontend's certificate. The only limitation of
14933 this mode is that the certificate's issuer will have to be known in order for
14934 the OCSP certid to be built.
14935 Each OCSP response will be updated at least once an hour, and even more
14936 frequently if a given OCSP response has an expire date earlier than this one
14937 hour limit. A minimum update interval of 5 minutes will still exist in order
14938 to avoid updating too often responses that have a really short expire time or
14939 even no 'Next Update' at all. Because of this hard limit, please note that
14940 when auto update is set to 'on' or 'auto', any OCSP response loaded during
14941 init will not be updated until at least 5 minutes, even if its expire time
14942 ends before now+5m. This should not be too much of a hassle since an OCSP
14943 response must be valid when it gets loaded during init (its expire time must
14944 be in the future) so it is unlikely that this response expires in such a
14945 short time after init.
14946 On the other hand, if a certificate has an OCSP uri specified and no OCSP
14947 response, setting this option to 'on' for the given certificate will ensure
14948 that the OCSP response gets fetched automatically right after init.
14949
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014950prefer-client-ciphers
14951 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
14952 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
14953 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014954 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14955 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14956 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014957
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014958proto <name>
14959 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14960 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14961 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014962 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14963 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14964
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014965 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14966 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14967 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014968
14969 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14970 a bind line :
14971
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014972 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014973 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14974 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14975
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014976 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014977 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014978 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014979 h2" on the bind line.
14980
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020014981quic-cc-algo [ cubic | newreno ]
14982 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
14983
14984 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
14985 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
14986 to those used by TCP.
14987
14988 Default value: cubic
14989
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020014990quic-force-retry
14991 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
14992 change without deprecation in the future.
14993
14994 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
14995 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
14996 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
14997 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
14998 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
14999 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
15000 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
Amaury Denoyelle996ca7d2022-11-14 16:17:13 +010015001 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting).
15002
15003 This setting requires the cluster secret to be set or else an error will be
15004 reported on startup (see "cluster-secret").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015005
15006 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
15007 information about QUIC retry.
15008
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015009shards <number> | by-thread
15010 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
15011 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
15012 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
15013 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
15014 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
15015 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
15016 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
15017 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
15018 little bit.
15019
15020 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
15021 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
15022 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
15023 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
15024 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
15025 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
15026
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015027ssl
15028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015029 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015030 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
15031 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020015032 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
15033 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015034
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015035ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15036 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015037 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
15038 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
15039 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015040 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15041
15042ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015043 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
15044 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
15045 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
15046 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015047
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015048strict-sni
15049 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
15050 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
15051 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
15052 See the "crt" option for more information.
15053
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015054tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015055 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015056 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015057 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015058 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015059 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
15060 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
15061 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
15062 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
15063 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
15064 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
15065 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15066
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015067tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010015068 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015069 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
15070 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
15071 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
15072 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
15073 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
15074 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
15075 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020015076 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
15077 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
15078 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015079
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015080thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>[,...]
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015081 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
15082 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
15083 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015084
15085 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
15086 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015087 It is also possible to designate a thread number using its relative number
15088 inside its thread group, by specifying the thread group number first, then a
15089 slash ('/') and the relative thread number(s). In this case thread numbers
15090 also start at 1 and end at 32 or 64 depending on the platform. When absolute
15091 thread numbers are specified, they will be automatically translated to
15092 relative numbers once thread groups are known. Usually, absolute numbers are
15093 preferred for simple configurations, and relative ones are preferred for
15094 complex configurations where CPU arrangement matters for performance.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015095
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015096 After the optional thread group number, the "thread-set" specification must
15097 use the following format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015098
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015099 "all" | "odd" | "even" | [number][-[number]]
15100
15101 As their names imply, "all" validates all threads within the set (either all
15102 of the group's when a group is specified, or all of the process' threads),
15103 "odd" validates all odd-numberred threads (every other thread starting at 1)
15104 either for the process or the group, and "even" validates all even-numberred
15105 threads (every other thread starting at 2). If instead thread number ranges
15106 are used, then all threads included in the range from the first to the last
15107 thread number are validated. The numbers are either relative to the group
15108 or absolute dependeing on the presence of a thread group number. If the first
15109 thread number is omitted, "1" is used, representing either the first thread
15110 of the group or the first thread of the process. If the last thread number is
15111 omitted, either the last thread number of the group (32 or 64) is used, or
15112 the last thread number of the process (global.nbthread).
15113
15114 These ranges may be repeated and delimited by a comma, so that non-contiguous
15115 thread sets can be specified, and the group, if present, must be specified
15116 again for each new range. Note that it is not permitted to mix group-relative
15117 and absolute specifications because the whole "bind" line must use either
15118 an absolute notation or a relative one, as those not set will be resolved at
15119 the end of the parsing.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015120
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015121 The main purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but
15122 not the same thread in a listener, so that the system can distribute the
15123 incoming connections into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue
15124 load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015125
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015126tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
15127 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010015128 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
15129 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
15130 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
15131 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
15132 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
15133 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
15134 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
15135 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
15136 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
15137 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015138 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
15139 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
15140
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015141transparent
15142 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15143 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
15144 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
15145 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
15146 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
15147 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
15148 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
15149 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
15150 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
15151 so check for support with your vendor.
15152
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015153v4v6
15154 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15155 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
15156 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
15157 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015158 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015159
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015160v6only
15161 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15162 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
15163 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015164 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
15165 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015166
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015167uid <uid>
15168 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
15169 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15170 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
15171 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
15172 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15173
15174user <user>
15175 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
15176 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15177 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
15178 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
15179 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15180
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015181verify [none|optional|required]
15182 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
15183 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
15184 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
15185 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
15186 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015187 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
15188 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
15189 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
15190 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020015191
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200151925.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015193------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015194
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015195The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
15196which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
15197arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
15198settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
15199after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
15200Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
15201address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015203 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015204 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015205
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015206Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
15207keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
15208
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015209The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015210
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015211addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015212 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010015213 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15214 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
15215 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
15216 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
15217 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015218
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015219agent-check
15220 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015221 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010015222 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
15223 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
15224 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015225
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015226 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015227 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015228 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020015229 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
15230 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015231
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015232 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
15233 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
15234 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
15235 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
15236 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020015237
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015238 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015239 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015240
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015241 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15242 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
15243 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015244
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015245 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15246 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
15247 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015248
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020015249 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015250 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
15251 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
15252 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
15253 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015254 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015255 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015256
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015257 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
15258 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015259
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015260 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
15261 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
15262 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
15263 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
15264 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
15265 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
15266 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
15267 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
15268 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015269
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015270 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
15271 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015272 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
15273 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
15274 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010015275 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015276
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015277 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015278 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015279
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015280agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015281 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015282 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
15283 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
15284 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
15285 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
15286
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015287agent-inter <delay>
15288 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
15289 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15290
15291 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
15292 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
15293 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
15294 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
15295 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15296 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15297 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15298 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15299 of backends use the same servers.
15300
15301 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
15302
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015303agent-addr <addr>
15304 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
15305
15306 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015307 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015308 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
15309 hostname, it will be resolved.
15310
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015311agent-port <port>
15312 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
15313
15314 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
15315
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015316allow-0rtt
15317 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020015318 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
15319 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015320
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015321alpn <protocols>
15322 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
15323 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
15324 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015325 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015326 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
15327 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
15328 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
15329 now obsolete NPN extension.
15330 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
15331 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
15332
15333 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
15334
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015335 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
15336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015337backup
15338 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
15339 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
15340 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
15341 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015342 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
15343 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015344
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015345ca-file <cafile>
15346 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15347 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015348 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
15349 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020015350 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015351
15352 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
15353 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
15354 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015356check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015357 This option enables health checks on a server:
15358 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
15359 considered available.
15360 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
15361 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
15362 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
15363 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
15364 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015365 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
15366 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015367 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
15368 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
15369 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
15370 exchanges succeed.
15371
15372 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
15373 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
15374 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
15375 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
15376 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050015377 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015378 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
15379
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015380 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020015381 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015382 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
15383 not overridden.
15384
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015385 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
15386 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
15387
15388 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
15389 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
15390
15391 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
15392 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
15393 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
15394 available.
15395
15396 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
15397 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
15398 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
15399
15400 Example:
15401 # simple tcp check
15402 backend foo
15403 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
15404 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
15405 backend foo
15406 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
15407 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
15408 backend foo
15409 option tcp-check
15410 tcp-check connect
15411 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015412
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020015413check-send-proxy
15414 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
15415 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
15416 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
15417 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
15418 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
15419 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
15420 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
15421
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010015422check-alpn <protocols>
15423 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
15424 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
15425 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
15426
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015427check-proto <name>
15428 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
15429 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
15430 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015431 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
15432 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15433
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015434 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15435 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15436 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015437
15438 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
15439 directive on a server line:
15440
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015441 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015442 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15443 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15444 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15445
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015446 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015447 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
15448 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
15449
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015450check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015451 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015452 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
15453 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015454
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015455check-ssl
15456 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
15457 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
15458 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
15459 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015460 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015461 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
15462 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015463 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015464 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
15465 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015466
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015467check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015468 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015469 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
15470 for normal traffic.
15471
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015472ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
15474 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
15475 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015476 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
15477 information and recommendations see e.g.
15478 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
15479 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
15480 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015481
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015482ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
15483 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
15484 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
15485 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
15486 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015487 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
15488 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
15489 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015491cookie <value>
15492 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
15493 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
15494 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
15495 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
15496 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
15497 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
15498 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
15499
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015500crl-file <crlfile>
15501 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15502 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
15503 to verify server's certificate.
15504
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020015505crt <cert>
15506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
15507 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
15508 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
15509 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
15510 certificate request.
15511
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020015512 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
15513 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
15514 option is set accordingly).
15515
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015516disabled
15517 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
15518 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
15519 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
15520 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
15521 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015522 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015523
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015524enabled
15525 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
15526 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
15527 default value.
15528 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
15529 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015530
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015531error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010015532 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
15533 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
15534 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015535
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015536 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015537
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015538fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015539 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
15540 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
15541 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
15542
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015543force-sslv3
15544 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15545 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015546 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015547 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015548
15549force-tlsv10
15550 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015551 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015552 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015553
15554force-tlsv11
15555 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015556 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015557 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015558
15559force-tlsv12
15560 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015561 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015562 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015563
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015564force-tlsv13
15565 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15566 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015567 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015569id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020015570 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
15571 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
15572 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015573
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015574init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
15575 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
15576 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015577 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015578 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
15579 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
15580 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
15581 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
15582 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
15583 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
15584 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
15585 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
15586 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015587 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015588 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
15589 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
15590 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
15591 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
15592 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
15593 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015594 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015595
15596 Example:
15597 defaults
15598 # never fail on address resolution
15599 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
15600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015601inter <delay>
15602fastinter <delay>
15603downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015604 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
15605 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15606 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
15607 between checks depending on the server state :
15608
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020015609 Server state | Interval used
15610 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15611 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
15612 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15613 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
15614 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
15615 or yet unchecked. |
15616 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15617 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
15618 | "inter" otherwise.
15619 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015621 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
15622 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
15623 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
15624 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015625 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15626 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15627 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15628 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15629 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015630
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020015631log-proto <logproto>
15632 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
15633 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
15634 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
15635 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
15636
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015637maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015638 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
15639 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015640 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
15641 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015642 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
15643 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
15644 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
15645 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
15646
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015647 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
15648 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
15649 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
15650 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
15651 than 50 concurrent requests.
15652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015653maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015654 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
15655 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
15656 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
15657 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020015658 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
15659 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
15660 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
15661 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
15662 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
15663 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
15664 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015665
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010015666max-reuse <count>
15667 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
15668 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
15669 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
15670 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
15671 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
15672 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
15673 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
15674 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
15675
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015676minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015677 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
15678 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
15679 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
15680 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
15681 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
15682 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015683 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015684 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015685
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015686namespace <name>
15687 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15688 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
15689 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15690 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15691
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015692no-agent-check
15693 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
15694 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15695 default value.
15696 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15697 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
15698
15699no-backup
15700 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
15701 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15702 default value.
15703 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15704 "default-server" "backup" setting.
15705
15706no-check
15707 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
15708 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15709 default value.
15710 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15711 "default-server" "check" setting.
15712
15713no-check-ssl
15714 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
15715 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15716 default value.
15717 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15718 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
15719
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015720no-send-proxy
15721 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
15722 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15723 default value.
15724 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15725 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
15726
15727no-send-proxy-v2
15728 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
15729 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15730 default value.
15731 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15732 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
15733
15734no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
15735 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
15736 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15737 default value.
15738 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15739 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
15740
15741no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15742 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
15743 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15744 default value.
15745 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15746 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
15747
15748no-ssl
15749 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
15750 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15751 default value.
15752 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15753 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
15754
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010015755 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
15756 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
15757 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
15758
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010015759no-ssl-reuse
15760 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
15761 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
15762 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
15763 and for paranoid users.
15764
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015765no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015766 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15767 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015768 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015769
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015770 Supported in default-server: No
15771
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015772no-tls-tickets
15773 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15774 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15775 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015776 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
15777 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015778 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15779 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15780 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015781 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015782
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015783no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015784 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015785 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15786 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015787 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15788 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015789 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015790
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015791 Supported in default-server: No
15792
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015793no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015794 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015795 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15796 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015797 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15798 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015799 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015800
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015801 Supported in default-server: No
15802
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015803no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015804 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015805 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15806 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015807 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15808 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015809 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015810
15811 Supported in default-server: No
15812
15813no-tlsv13
15814 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15815 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15816 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
15817 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15818 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015819 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015820
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015821 Supported in default-server: No
15822
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015823no-verifyhost
15824 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
15825 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15826 default value.
15827 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15828 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015829
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015830no-tfo
15831 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
15832 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15833 default value.
15834 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15835 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
15836
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090015837non-stick
15838 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
15839 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
15840 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
15841
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015842npn <protocols>
15843 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15844 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15845 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015846 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015847 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
15848 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15849 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
15850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015851observe <mode>
15852 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
15853 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
15854 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
15855 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
15856 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
15857 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010015858 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015859
15860 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
15861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015862on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015863 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
15864 Currently, four modes are available:
15865 - fastinter: force fastinter
15866 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
15867 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
15868 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
15869 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
15870
15871 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
15872
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015873on-marked-down <action>
15874 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
15875 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015876 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
15877 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
15878 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
15879 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
15880 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
15881 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
15882 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
15883 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015884
15885 Actions are disabled by default
15886
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015887on-marked-up <action>
15888 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
15889 Currently one action is available:
15890 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
15891 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
15892 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
15893 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015894 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
15895 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015896 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
15897 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
15898
15899 Actions are disabled by default
15900
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015901pool-low-conn <max>
15902 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
15903 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
15904 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
15905 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
15906 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
15907 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
15908 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
15909 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
15910 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
15911 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010015912 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
15913 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
15914 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
15915 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015916
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010015917pool-max-conn <max>
15918 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
15919 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
15920 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
15921 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
15922 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
15923 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
15924
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015925pool-purge-delay <delay>
15926 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010015927 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020015928 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015930port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015931 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010015932 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15933 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
15934 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
15935 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
15936 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015937
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015938proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015939 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
15940 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
15941 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015942 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
15943 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15944
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015945 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15946 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15947 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015948
15949 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15950 a server line :
15951
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015952 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015953 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15954 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15955 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15956
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015957 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015958 protocol for all connections established to this server.
15959
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015960 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
15961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015962redir <prefix>
15963 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
15964 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
15965 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
15966 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
15967 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
15968 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
15969 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
15970 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015971 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015972 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015973 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
15974 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
15975 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
15976 loop between the client and HAProxy!
15977
15978 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
15979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015980rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015981 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
15982 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
15983 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
15984
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015985resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
15986 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
15987 server.
15988
15989 Available options:
15990
15991 * allow-dup-ip
15992 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
15993 resolution at runtime is in operation.
15994 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
15995 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
15996 For such case, simply enable this option.
15997 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
15998
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050015999 * ignore-weight
16000 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
16001 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
16002 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
16003
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016004 * prevent-dup-ip
16005 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
16006 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
16007 same fqdn.
16008 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
16009
16010 Example:
16011 backend b_myapp
16012 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
16013 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16014 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16015
16016 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
16017 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
16018 it
16019 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
16020 different address
16021
16022 Default value: not set
16023
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016024resolve-prefer <family>
16025 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
16026 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
16027 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
16028 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
16029
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020016030 Default value: ipv6
16031
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016032 Example:
16033
16034 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016035
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016036resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016037 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016038 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016039 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016040 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
16041 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016042 configured network, another address is selected.
16043
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016044 Example:
16045
16046 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016047
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016048resolvers <id>
16049 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
16050 hostname.
16051
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016052 Example:
16053
16054 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016055
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016056 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016057
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016058send-proxy
16059 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
16060 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
16061 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
16062 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016063 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
16064 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
16065 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
16066 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016067 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016068 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
16069 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
16070 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
16071 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
16072 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016073 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
16074 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016075
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016076send-proxy-v2
16077 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
16078 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16079 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16080 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020016081 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
16082 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
16083 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
16084 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016085
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016086proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010016087 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
16088 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
16089
16090 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
16091 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
16092 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
16093 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
16094 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
16095 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
16096 connection is supported).
16097 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
16098 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
16099 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
16100 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
16101 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
16102 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
16103 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016104
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016105send-proxy-v2-ssl
16106 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16107 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16108 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16109 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16110 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16111 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
16112 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016113 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
16114 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016115
16116send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16117 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16118 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16119 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16120 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16121 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16122 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
16123 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
16124 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016125 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
16126 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016127
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +020016128shard <shard>
16129 This parameter in used only in the context of stick-tables synchronisation
16130 with peers protocol. The "shard" parameter identifies the peers which will
16131 receive all the stick-table updates for keys with this shard as distribution
16132 hash. The accepted values are 0 up to "shards" parameter value specified in
16133 the "peers" section. 0 value is the default value meaning that the peer will
16134 receive all the key updates. Greater values than "shards" will be ignored.
16135 This is also the case for any value provided to the local peer.
16136
16137 Example :
16138
16139 peers mypeers
16140 shards 3
16141 peer A 127.0.0.1:40001 # local peer without shard value (0 internally)
16142 peer B 127.0.0.1:40002 shard 1
16143 peer C 127.0.0.1:40003 shard 2
16144 peer D 127.0.0.1:40004 shard 3
16145
16146
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016147slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016148 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
16149 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
16150 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
16151 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
16152 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
16153 parameters :
16154
16155 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
16156 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
16157
16158 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
16159 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
16160 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
16161 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
16162
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016163 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016164 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
16165 seen as failed.
16166
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016167sni <expression>
16168 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
16169 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
16170 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010016171 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
16172 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
16173 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
16174 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020016175 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016176 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010016177 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
16178 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016179
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016180source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020016181source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016182source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016183 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
16184 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
16185 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
16186 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
16187
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016188 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
16189 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
16190 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
16191 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
16192 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
16193 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
16194 server.
16195
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000016196 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
16197 specifying the source address without port(s).
16198
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016199ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020016200 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
16201 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
16202 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
16203 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
16204 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
16205 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016206 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
16207 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016208
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016209ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16210 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
16211 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16212 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
16213
16214ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16215 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
16216 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16217 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
16218
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016219ssl-reuse
16220 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
16221 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16222 default value.
16223 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16224 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
16225
16226stick
16227 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
16228 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16229 default value.
16230 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16231 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016232
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016233socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016234 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016235 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
16236 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
16237
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016238tcp-ut <delay>
16239 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016240 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016241 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016242 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016243 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
16244 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
16245 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
16246 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
16247 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
16248 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
16249 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
16250 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
16251 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
16252
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016253tfo
16254 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
16255 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
16256 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
16257 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016258 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016259 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016261track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020016262 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
16263 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
16264 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
16265 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016266 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
16267
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016268tls-tickets
16269 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
16270 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16271 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016272 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16273 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16274 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016275 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010016276 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016277
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016278verify [none|required]
16279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010016280 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016281 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
16282 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016283 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016284 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
16285 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
16286 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
16287 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
16288 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
16289 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
16290 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
16291 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016292
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016293verifyhost <hostname>
16294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016295 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
16296 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
16297 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
16298 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
16299 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
16300 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
16301 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
16302 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016303
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016304weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016305 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
16306 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
16307 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020016308 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
16309 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
16310 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
16311 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
16312 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
16313 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016314
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016315ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
16316 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
16317 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
16318 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
16319
16320 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
16321 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
16322 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
16323 server ALPN contains it.
16324
16325 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
16326 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
16327 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
16328 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
16329
16330 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
16331 favor of the ALPN extension.
16332
16333 See also "alpn" and "proto".
16334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016335
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200163365.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
16337-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016338
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016339HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
16340using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070016341configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016342This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
16343can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
16344workload.
16345This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
16346resolution at run time.
16347Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
16348carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
16349
16350
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200163515.3.1. Global overview
16352----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016353
16354As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
16355different steps of the process life:
16356
16357 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
16358 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
16359 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
16360
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016361 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
16362 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016363
16364A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
16365 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
16366 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
16367 resolution to know this new IP.
16368
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016369When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016370HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016371SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
16372from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016373will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016374will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020016375
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016376A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016377 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016378 first valid response.
16379
16380 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
16381 servers return an error.
16382
16383
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200163845.3.2. The resolvers section
16385----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016386
16387This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016388HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
16389contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016390
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020016391At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
16392no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
16393default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
16394failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
16395
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016396When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
16397uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
16398is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
16399answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
16400
16401When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016402used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016403
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016404 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
16405 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
16406 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016407
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016408 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
16409 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016410
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010016411 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016412 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
16413 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016414
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016415For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
16416following scenarios are possible:
16417
16418 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
16419 ignored
16420
16421 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
16422 applied
16423
16424 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
16425 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
16426
16427 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
16428 retries the query with a new type
16429
16430 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
16431 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016432
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016433As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016434a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016435<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016436
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016437
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016438resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016439 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016440
16441A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
16442
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016443accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016444 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016445 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016446 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
16447 by RFC 6891)
16448
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010016449 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
16450 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
16451 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
16452 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
16453 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
16454 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020016455
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016456nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
16457 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
16458 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
16459 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
16460 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
16461 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
16462 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
16463 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
16464 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
16465 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010016466 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
16467
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016468parse-resolv-conf
16469 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
16470 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
16471 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
16472
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016473hold <status> <period>
16474 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
16475 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010016476 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016477 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016478 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
16479 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
16480 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
16481
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020016482 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016483
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016484resolve_retries <nb>
16485 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
16486 giving up.
16487 Default value: 3
16488
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016489 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
16490 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
16491 type.
16492
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016493timeout <event> <time>
16494 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
16495 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
16496 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016497 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
16498 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016499 Default value: 1s
16500 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016501 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016502 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016503 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
16504 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
16505
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016506 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016507
16508 resolvers mydns
16509 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
16510 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016511 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016512 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016513 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016514 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016515 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010016516 hold other 30s
16517 hold refused 30s
16518 hold nx 30s
16519 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016520 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016521 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016522
16523
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200165246. Cache
16525---------
16526
16527HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
16528(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
16529RAM.
16530
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020016531The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
16532blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016533
16534If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
16535independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
16536when we try to allocate a new one.
16537
16538The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
16539
16540It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
16541"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
16542for more details.
16543
16544When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
16545replaced by "<CACHE>".
16546
16547
165486.1. Limitation
16549----------------
16550
16551The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
16552
16553- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010016554- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
16555 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
16556 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016557- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
16558- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010016559- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
16560 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
16561 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016562- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
16563 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010016564- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
16565 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
16566 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016567
16568- If the request is not a GET
16569- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
16570- If the request contains an Authorization header
16571
16572
165736.2. Setup
16574-----------
16575
16576To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
16577the corresponding http-request and response actions.
16578
16579
165806.2.1. Cache section
16581---------------------
16582
16583cache <name>
16584 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
16585 size of cache is mandatory.
16586
16587total-max-size <megabytes>
16588 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
16589 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
16590
16591max-object-size <bytes>
16592 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
16593 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
16594 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
16595
16596max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016597 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016598 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
16599 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
16600 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
16601 default.
16602
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016603process-vary <on/off>
16604 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016605 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
16606 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
16607 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016608 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016609
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016610max-secondary-entries <number>
16611 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
16612 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
16613 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
16614
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016615
166166.2.2. Proxy section
16617---------------------
16618
16619http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16620 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
16621 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
16622 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
16623 after this one.
16624
16625http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16626 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
16627 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
16628 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
16629 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
16630
16631
16632Example:
16633
16634 backend bck1
16635 mode http
16636
16637 http-request cache-use foobar
16638 http-response cache-store foobar
16639 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
16640
16641 cache foobar
16642 total-max-size 4
16643 max-age 240
16644
16645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200166467. Using ACLs and fetching samples
16647----------------------------------
16648
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016649HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016650client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
16651The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
16652these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
16653but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
16654data called patterns.
16655
16656
166577.1. ACL basics
16658---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016659
16660The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
16661content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
16662from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
16663simple :
16664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016665 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016666 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016667 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
16668 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016670The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
16671adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016672
16673In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
16674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016675 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016676
16677This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
16678Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
16679and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016680an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
16681conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
16682as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
16683are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016684
16685ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
16686'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
16687which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
16688
16689There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
16690performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
16691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016692The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
16693specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
16694this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016695methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
16696ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016697
16698Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
16699 - boolean
16700 - integer (signed or unsigned)
16701 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
16702 - string
16703 - data block
16704
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016705Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
16706converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
16707would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
16708The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
16709which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
16710
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016711Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
16712keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
16713fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
16714which are summarized in the table below :
16715
16716 +---------------------+-----------------+
16717 | Sample or converter | Default |
16718 | output type | matching method |
16719 +---------------------+-----------------+
16720 | boolean | bool |
16721 +---------------------+-----------------+
16722 | integer | int |
16723 +---------------------+-----------------+
16724 | ip | ip |
16725 +---------------------+-----------------+
16726 | string | str |
16727 +---------------------+-----------------+
16728 | binary | none, use "-m" |
16729 +---------------------+-----------------+
16730
16731Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
16732matching method, see below.
16733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016734The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
16735 - boolean
16736 - integer or integer range
16737 - IP address / network
16738 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
16739 - regular expression
16740 - hex block
16741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016742The following ACL flags are currently supported :
16743
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016744 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
16745 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016746 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016747 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016748 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016749 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016750 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
16751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016752The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
16753read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
16754if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
16755lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
16756will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
16757beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016758a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016759lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
16760exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
16761
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016762The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
16763parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
16764ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
16765a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
16766check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
16767
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016768The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
16769socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
16770file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
16771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016772Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
16773loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
16774
16775 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
16776
16777In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
16778the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
16779case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
16780as well.
16781
16782The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
16783sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
16784do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
16785methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
16786is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016787obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016788followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
16789default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
16790that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
16791string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
16792
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016793The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
16794By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
16795string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
16796resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016797server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016798waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016799flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
16800function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
16801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016802There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
16803sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
16804be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016805
16806 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
16807 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016808 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
16809 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
16810 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
16811 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016812
16813 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
16814 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016815 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016816
16817 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016818 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016819
16820 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016821 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016822
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016823 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016824 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
16825
16826 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
16827 binary or string samples.
16828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016829 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
16830 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016832 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
16833 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
16834 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016836 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
16837 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016839 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
16840 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016842 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
16843 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016845 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
16846 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016847 This may be used with binary or string samples.
16848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016849 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
16850 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
16851 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016852
16853For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
16854request, it is possible to do :
16855
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016856 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016857
16858In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
16859buffer, one would use the following acl :
16860
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016861 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016862
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016863On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
16864possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
16865
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016866 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016868All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
16869criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
16870method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreau4f4fea42022-11-25 10:49:41 +010016871to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
16872usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
16873converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
16874method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
16875matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016876criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
16877the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016879If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016880the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
16881For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016883 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
16884 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
16885 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
16886 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016887
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016888
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016889The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
16890types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
16891combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
16892brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
16893default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016895 +-------------------------------------------------+
16896 | Input sample type |
16897 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016898 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016899 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16900 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
16901 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016902 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016903 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016904 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016905 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016906 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016907 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016908 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016909 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016910 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016911 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016912 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016913 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016914 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016915 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016916 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016917 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016918 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016919 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016920 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016921 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016922 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016923 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16924 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
16925 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016926
16927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169287.1.1. Matching booleans
16929------------------------
16930
16931In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
16932Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
16933When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
16934that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
16935
16936Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
16937return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
16938"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
16939
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169417.1.2. Matching integers
16942------------------------
16943
16944Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
16945enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
16946to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
16947
16948Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
16949matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
16950lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016951
16952For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
16953unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
16954representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
16955
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016956As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
16957two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
16958instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
16959ranges and operators.
16960
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016961For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016962operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
16963Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
16964of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016965
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016966Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016967
16968 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
16969 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
16970 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
16971 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
16972 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
16973
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016974For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016975
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016976 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016977
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016978This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
16979
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016980 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016981
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169837.1.3. Matching strings
16984-----------------------
16985
16986String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
16987different forms :
16988
16989 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016990 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016991
16992 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016993 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016994
16995 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
16996 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16997
16998 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
16999 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17000
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017001 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17002 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
17003 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
17004 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
17005 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
17006 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017007
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017008 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17009 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
17010 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
17011 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
17012 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
17013 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
17014 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
17015 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
17016 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
17017 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
17018 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017019
17020String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
17021exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
17022characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
17023string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
17024to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017025before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017026
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010017027Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
17028(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
17029Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
17030
17031Example:
17032 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
17033 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
17034
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200170367.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
17037---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017038
17039Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
17040they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
17041possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
17042passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
17043the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017044the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
17045match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017046
17047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200170487.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
17049-------------------------------------
17050
17051It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
17052not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
17053a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
17054to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
17055digits may be used upper or lower case.
17056
17057Example :
17058 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017059 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017060
17061
170627.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
17063---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017064
17065IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
17066netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
17067within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010017068host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017069difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
17070at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
17071does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
17072parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017073
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020017074The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
17075abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
17076
17077 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17078 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
17079 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17080 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
17081 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
17082 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
17083 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
17084 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17085
17086Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
17087192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
17088
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020017089IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
17090Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
17091trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
17092IPv6 patterns.
17093
17094HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
17095following situations :
17096 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
17097 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
17098 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
17099 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
17100 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
17101 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
17102 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
17103 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
17104 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
17105 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
17106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017107
171087.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
17109----------------------------------
17110
17111Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
17112combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
17113
17114 - AND (implicit)
17115 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
17116 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017118A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017120 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017122Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
17123indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017125For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
17126"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
17127requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
17128is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
17129
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017130 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017131 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
17132 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
17133 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017134
17135To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
17136and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
17137
17138 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
17139 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
17140 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
17141 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
17142
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017143 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017144 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
17145 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
17146 use_backend www if host_www
17147
17148It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
17149expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
17150be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
17151the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
17152
17153 The following rule :
17154
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017155 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017156 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017157
17158 Can also be written that way :
17159
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017160 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017161
17162It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
17163to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
17164simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
17165sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
17166good use is the following :
17167
17168 With named ACLs :
17169
17170 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
17171 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
17172 monitor fail if site_dead
17173
17174 With anonymous ACLs :
17175
17176 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
17177
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017178See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
17179keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017180
17181
171827.3. Fetching samples
17183---------------------
17184
17185Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
17186against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
17187sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
17188ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
17189of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
17190available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
17191
17192This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
17193Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
17194compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
17195deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
17196
17197The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
17198matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
17199method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
17200indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
17201
17202As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
17203when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
17204mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
17205the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
17206ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
17207
17208Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
17209multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
17210when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017211incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
17212are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017213is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
17214all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
17215
17216Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
17217 - name
17218 - name(arg1)
17219 - name(arg1,arg2)
17220
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017221
172227.3.1. Converters
17223-----------------
17224
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017225Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
17226of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
17227is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
17228was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017229has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017230unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
17231
17232These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
17233sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
17234the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017235support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017236
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017237A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
17238support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
17239supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
17240(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
17241bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
17242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017243The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017244
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001724551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
17246 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17247 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17248 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
17249 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17250 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17251
17252 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017253 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
17254 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000017255 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
17256 frontend http-in
17257 bind *:8081
17258 default_backend servers
17259 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17260 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17261
Aurelien DARRAGON5c6f86f2022-12-30 16:23:08 +010017262rfc7239_is_valid
17263 Returns true if input header is RFC 7239 compliant header value and false
17264 otherwise.
17265
17266 Example:
17267 acl valid req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_is_valid
17268 #input: "for=127.0.0.1;proto=http"
17269 # output: TRUE
17270 #input: "proto=custom"
17271 # output: FALSE
17272
Aurelien DARRAGON6fb58b82022-12-30 16:37:03 +010017273rfc7239_field(<field>)
17274 Extracts a single field/parameter from RFC 7239 compliant header value input.
17275
17276 Supported fields are:
17277 - proto: either 'http' or 'https'
17278 - host: http compliant host
17279 - for: RFC7239 node
17280 - by: RFC7239 node
17281
17282 More info here:
17283 https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html#section-6
17284
17285 Example:
17286 # extract host field from forwarded header and store it in req.fhost var
17287 http-request set-var(req.fhost) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(host)
17288 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\""
17289 # output: "haproxy.org:80"
17290
17291 # extract for field from forwarded header and store it in req.ffor var
17292 http-request set-var(req.ffor) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for)
17293 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\";for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17294 # output: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17295
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017296rfc7239_n2nn
17297 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17298 into its corresponding nodename final form:
17299 - ipv4 address
17300 - ipv6 address
17301 - 'unknown'
17302 - '_obfs' identifier
17303
17304 Example:
17305 # extract 'for' field from forwarded header, extract nodename from
17306 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnn
17307 http-request set-var(req.fnn) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for),rfc7239_n2nn
17308 #input: "for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17309 # output: 127.0.0.1
17310 #input: "for=\"_name:_port\""
17311 # output: "_name"
17312
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017313rfc7239_n2np
17314 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17315 into its corresponding nodeport final form:
17316 - unsigned integer
17317 - '_obfs' identifier
17318
17319 Example:
17320 # extract 'by' field from forwarded header, extract node port from
17321 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnp
17322 http-request set-var(req.fnp) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(by),rfc7239_n2np
17323 #input: "by=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17324 # output: 9999
17325 #input: "by=\"_name:_port\""
17326 # output: "_port"
17327
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017328add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017329 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017330 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017331 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17332 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017333 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017334 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17335 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17336 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17337 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017338 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017339 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017340
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017341add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
17342 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
17343 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
17344 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
17345 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
17346 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17347 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
17348 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
17349 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
17350 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
17351 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
17352 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
17353 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
17354 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
17355 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
17356 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
17357 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
17358 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreaub143d112022-11-25 09:27:15 +010017359 level parser (please see section 2.2 for quoting and escaping). See examples
17360 below.
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017361
17362 Example:
17363 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
17364 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
17365 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
17366 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
17367
17368 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
17369 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
17370
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010017371aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
17372 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
17373 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
17374 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
17375 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
17376 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
17377 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
17378
17379 Example:
17380 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
17381 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
17382
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017383and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017384 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017385 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017386 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17387 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017388 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017389 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17390 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17391 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17392 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017393 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017394 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017395
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017396b64dec
17397 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
17398 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017399 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
17400 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017401
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017402base64
17403 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017404 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017405 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
17406 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017407
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020017408be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
17409 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
17410 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
17411 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
17412 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
17413 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
17414
17415 Example:
17416 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
17417 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
17418 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
17419 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
17420
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020017421be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
17422 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
17423 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
17424 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
17425 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
17426 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
17427 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
17428
17429 Example:
17430 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
17431 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
17432 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
17433 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
17434
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017435bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017436 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017437 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017438 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017439 presence of a flag).
17440
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017441bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
17442 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
17443 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017444 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017445
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017446concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
17447 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
17448 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
17449 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
17450 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17451 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
17452 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
17453 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
17454 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
17455 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
17456 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017457 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040017458 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017459 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017460 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
17461 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
17462 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017463
17464 Example:
17465 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
17466 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
17467 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017468 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017469 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017470 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
17471
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017472cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017473 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
17474 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017475
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010017476crc32([<avalanche>])
17477 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
17478 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17479 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17480 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17481 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17482 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
17483 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
17484 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
17485 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
17486 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017487 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
17488
17489crc32c([<avalanche>])
17490 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
17491 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17492 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17493 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
17494 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
17495 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
17496 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
17497 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010017498
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020017499cut_crlf
17500 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
17501 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
17502 updated.
17503
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010017504da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017505 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
17506 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
17507 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
17508 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017509 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017510 configuration language.
17511
17512 Example:
17513 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017514 bind *:8881
17515 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000017516 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017517
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010017518debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
17519 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
17520 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
17521 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
17522 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
17523 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
17524 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
17525 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
17526 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
17527 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
17528 printable sample types.
17529
17530 Example:
17531 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020017532
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017533digest(<algorithm>)
17534 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
17535 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
17536
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017537 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017538 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17539
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017540div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017541 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17542 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017543 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017544 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
17545 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017546 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017547 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17548 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17549 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17550 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017551 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017552 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017553
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017554djb2([<avalanche>])
17555 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
17556 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17557 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17558 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17559 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17560 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17561 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017562 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
17563 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017564
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017565even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017566 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017567 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
17568
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017569field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17570 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
17571 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
17572 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
17573 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
17574 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
17575 fields.
17576
17577 Example :
17578 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
17579 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17580 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
17581 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
17582 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010017583
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017584fix_is_valid
17585 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
17586 Information eXchange):
17587
17588 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
17589 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050017590 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017591 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010017592 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017593 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
17594 checksum
17595
17596 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17597 the server can be parsed.
17598
17599 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
17600 message, false if not.
17601
17602 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
17603
17604 Example:
17605 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17606 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17607
17608fix_tag_value(<tag>)
17609 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
17610 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
17611 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
17612 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050017613 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017614 added.
17615
17616 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17617 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
17618 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
17619 fix_is_valid converter.
17620
17621 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
17622
17623 Example:
17624 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17625 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17626 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
17627 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
17628 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
17629
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017630hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017631 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017632 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017633 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017634 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010017635
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017636hex2i
17637 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017638 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017639
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020017640htonl
17641 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
17642 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
17643 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
17644 unsigned 32-bit integer.
17645
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017646hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017647 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
17648 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
17649 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
17650 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
17651
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017652 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017653 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17654
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020017655host_only
17656 Converts a string which contains a Host header value and removes its port.
17657 The input must respect the format of the host header value
17658 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
17659 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
17660
17661 This converter also sets the string in lowercase.
17662
17663 See also: "port_only" converter which will return the port.
17664
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017665http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017666 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17667 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017668 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
17669 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
17670 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
17671 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
17672 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
17673 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
17674 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
17675 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017676
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017677iif(<true>,<false>)
17678 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
17679 string otherwise.
17680
17681 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020017682 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017683
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017684in_table(<table>)
17685 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17686 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
17687 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017688 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017689 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
17690
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017691ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017692 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017693 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017694 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
17695 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
17696 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
17697 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
17698 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017699
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017700json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017701 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017702 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017703 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017704 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
17705 of errors:
17706 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
17707 bytes, ...)
17708 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
17709 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
17710
17711 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
17712 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
17713 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
17714 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
17715 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
17716 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017717 - "ascii" : never fails;
17718 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
17719 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017720 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017721 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017722 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
17723 characters corresponding to the other errors.
17724
17725 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017726 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017727
17728 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017729 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017730 capture request header user-agent len 150
17731 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017732
17733 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
17734 GET / HTTP/1.0
17735 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
17736
17737 Output log:
17738 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
17739
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020017740json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
17741 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
17742 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
17743 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
17744 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
17745
17746 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
17747 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
17748
17749 Example:
17750 # get a integer value from the request body
17751 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
17752 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
17753
17754 # get a key with '.' in the name
17755 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
17756 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
17757
17758 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
17759 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
17760
17761 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
17762 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
17763
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020017764jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17765 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
17766 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
17767 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
17768 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17769 json_path and output_type parameters.
17770
17771 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17772 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17773
17774jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17775 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
17776 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
17777 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
17778 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17779 json_path and output_type parameters.
17780
17781 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17782 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17783
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017784jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
17785 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
17786 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017787 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017788 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
17789 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
17790 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
17791 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017792
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017793 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
17794 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
17795 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
17796 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017797
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017798 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
17799 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
17800 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
17801 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
17802 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
17803 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017804 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017805 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
17806
17807 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
17808 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
17809 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
17810 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
17811 contents.
17812
17813 The possible return values are the following :
17814
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017815 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
17816 | ID | message |
17817 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017818 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017819 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017820 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
17821 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
17822 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
17823 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
17824 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017825 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017826
17827 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17828 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17829
17830 Example:
17831 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
17832 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
17833 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
17834 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
17835 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
17836 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
17837
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017838language(<value>[,<default>])
17839 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
17840 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
17841 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
17842 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
17843 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
17844 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
17845 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
17846 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
17847 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017848 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017849 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
17850 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017851
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017852 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017853
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017854 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
17855 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017856
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017857 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
17858 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
17859 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
17860 use_backend spanish if es
17861 use_backend french if fr
17862 use_backend english if en
17863 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017864
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010017865length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010017866 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
17867 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17868 type. The result is of type integer.
17869
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017870lower
17871 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
17872 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17873 type. The result is of type string.
17874
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017875ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
17876 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17877 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
17878 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17879 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17880 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17881 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
17882
17883 Example :
17884
17885 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017886 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017887 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17888
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020017889ltrim(<chars>)
17890 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
17891 representation of the input sample.
17892
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017893map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17894map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17895map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17896 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
17897 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
17898 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
17899 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
17900 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
17901 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
17902 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
17903 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017904
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017905 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
17906 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
17907 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017908
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017909 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017910 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017911
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017912 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
17913 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17914 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
17915 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020017916 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
17917 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017918 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
17919 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17920 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
17921 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17922 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
17923 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17924 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
17925 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080017926 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
17927 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17928 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017929 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17930 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
17931 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17932 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
17933 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017934
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010017935 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
17936 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
17937 the corresponding match text.
17938
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017939 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
17940 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
17941 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
17942 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
17943 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017944
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017945 Example :
17946
17947 # this is a comment and is ignored
17948 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
17949 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
17950 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
17951 | | | `---------- value
17952 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
17953 | `---------------------------- key
17954 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
17955
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017956mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017957 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17958 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017959 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017960 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017961 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017962 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17963 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17964 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17965 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017966 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017967 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017968
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017969mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017970 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
17971 <packettype>.
17972 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
17973 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
17974 from.
17975 Supported string and integers can be found here:
17976 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
17977 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
17978
17979 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
17980 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
17981 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
17982 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
17983
17984 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
17985 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
17986 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17987 packets only):
17988 17: Session Expiry Interval
17989 33: Receive Maximum
17990 39: Maximum Packet Size
17991 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17992 25: Request Response Information
17993 23: Request Problem Information
17994 21: Authentication Method
17995 22: Authentication Data
17996 18: Will Delay Interval
17997 1: Payload Format Indicator
17998 2: Message Expiry Interval
17999 3: Content Type
18000 8: Response Topic
18001 9: Correlation Data
18002 Not supported yet:
18003 38: User Property
18004
18005 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
18006 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18007 packets only):
18008 17: Session Expiry Interval
18009 33: Receive Maximum
18010 36: Maximum QoS
18011 37: Retain Available
18012 39: Maximum Packet Size
18013 18: Assigned Client Identifier
18014 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18015 31: Reason String
18016 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
18017 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
18018 42: Shared Subscription Available
18019 19: Server Keep Alive
18020 26: Response Information
18021 28: Server Reference
18022 21: Authentication Method
18023 22: Authentication Data
18024 Not supported yet:
18025 38: User Property
18026
18027 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18028 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18029 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18030 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18031
18032 Example:
18033
18034 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
18035 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18036 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
18037 if data_in_buffer
18038 # do the same as above
18039 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18040 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
18041 if data_in_buffer
18042
18043mqtt_is_valid
18044 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
18045
18046 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18047 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18048 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18049 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18050
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010018051 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
18052
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018053 Example:
18054
18055 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040018056 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018057
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018058mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018059 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020018060 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
18061 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018062 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018063 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018064 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018065 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18066 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18067 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18068 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018069 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018070 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018071
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010018072nbsrv
18073 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
18074 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
18075 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
18076 map lookup.
18077
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018078neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018079 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
18080 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
18081 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
18082 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018083
18084not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018085 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018086 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018087 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018088 absence of a flag).
18089
18090odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018091 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018092 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
18093
18094or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018095 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018096 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018097 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18098 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018099 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018100 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18101 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18102 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18103 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018104 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018105 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018106
Thayne McCombs02cf4ec2022-12-14 00:19:59 -070018107param(<name>,[<delim>])
18108 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the input string
18109 where parameters are delimited by <delim>, which defaults to "&", and the name
18110 and value of the parameter are separated by a "=". If there is no "=" and
18111 value before the end of the parameter segment, it is treated as equivalent to
18112 a value of an empty string.
18113
18114 This can be useful for extracting parameters from a query string, or possibly
18115 a x-www-form-urlencoded body. In particular, `query,param(<name>)` can be used
18116 as an alternative to `urlp(<name>)` which only uses "&" as a delimiter,
18117 whereas "urlp" also uses "?" and ";".
18118
18119 Note that this converter doesn't do anything special with url encoded
18120 characters. If you want to decode the value, you can use the url_dec converter
18121 on the output. If the name of the parameter in the input might contain encoded
18122 characters, you'll probably want do normalize the input before calling
18123 "param". This can be done using "http-request normalize-uri", in particular
18124 the percent-decode-unreserved and percent-to-uppercase options.
18125
18126 Example :
18127 str(a=b&c=d&a=r),param(a) # b
18128 str(a&b=c),param(a) # ""
18129 str(a=&b&c=a),param(b) # ""
18130 str(a=1;b=2;c=4),param(b,;) # 2
18131 query,param(redirect_uri),urldec()
18132
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018133port_only
18134 Converts a string which contains a Host header value into an integer by
18135 returning its port.
18136 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18137 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18138 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18139
18140 If no port were provided in the input, it will return 0.
18141
18142 See also: "host_only" converter which will return the host.
18143
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018144protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
18145 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
18146 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
18147 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
18148 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
18149 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18150 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18151 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18152 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
18153 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
18154 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18155 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
18156
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010018157regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018158 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
18159 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
18160 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
18161 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
18162 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
18163 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
18164 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
18165 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
18166 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018167 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
18168 of characters with other ones.
18169
18170 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
18171 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
18172 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
18173 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
18174 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
18175 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018176
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018177 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018178
18179 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
18180 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
18181 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018182 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018183
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018184 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
18185 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
18186
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018187 # capture groups and backreferences
18188 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020018189 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018190 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
18191
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018192capture-req(<id>)
18193 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
18194 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18195
18196 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018197 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18198 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018199
18200capture-res(<id>)
18201 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
18202 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18203
18204 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018205 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18206 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018207
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020018208rtrim(<chars>)
18209 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
18210 of the input sample.
18211
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018212sdbm([<avalanche>])
18213 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
18214 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18215 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18216 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18217 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18218 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18219 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018220 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
18221 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018222
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018223secure_memcmp(<var>)
18224 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
18225 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
18226 match.
18227
18228 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
18229 performed in constant time.
18230
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018231 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018232 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18233
18234 Example :
18235
18236 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
18237 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
18238 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
18239 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
18240
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018241set-var(<var>[,<cond> ...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018242 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018243 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
18244 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
18245 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18246 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018247 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018248 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18249 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018250 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018251 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18252 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018253 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018254 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018255
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018256 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
18257 possible conditions :
18258 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
18259 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
18260 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
18261 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
18262 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
18263 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
18264 Checks if the input is empty or not.
18265 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
18266 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
18267 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
18268 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
18269 called on the variable.
18270 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
18271 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
18272 configuration parsing.
18273 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
18274 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
18275 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
18276 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
18277 true by default.
18278
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018279sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018280 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018281 sample with length of 20 bytes.
18282
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018283sha2([<bits>])
18284 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
18285 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
18286
18287 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
18288 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
18289
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018290 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018291 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18292
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020018293srv_queue
18294 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
18295 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
18296 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
18297 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
18298 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
18299
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018300strcmp(<var>)
18301 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
18302 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
18303 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
18304 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
18305 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
18306 shorter).
18307
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018308 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
18309 strings in constant time.
18310
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018311 Example :
18312
18313 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
18314 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
18315 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
18316
18317
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018318sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018319 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
18320 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018321 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018322 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
18323 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018324 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018325 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18326 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018327 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018328 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18329 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018330 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018331 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018332
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018333table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
18334 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18335 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18336 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
18337 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18338 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18339 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
18340
18341
18342table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
18343 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18344 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18345 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
18346 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18347 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18348 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
18349
18350table_conn_cnt(<table>)
18351 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18352 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018353 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018354 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
18355 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18356
18357table_conn_cur(<table>)
18358 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18359 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18360 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18361 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18362 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
18363
18364table_conn_rate(<table>)
18365 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18366 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18367 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
18368 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18369 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
18370
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018371table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
18372 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18373 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18374 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18375 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
18376 input sample in the designated table.
18377 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
18378
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018379table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
18380 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18381 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18382 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
18383 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
18384 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18385 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18386 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
18387 data-type).
18388 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18389
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018390table_gpt0(<table>)
18391 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18392 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18393 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18394 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18395 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
18396
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018397table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
18398 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18399 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18400 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
18401 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
18402 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
18403 between 0 and 99.
18404 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18405 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18406 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18407 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
18408
18409table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
18410 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18411 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18412 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
18413 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
18414 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
18415 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18416 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
18417 value 0.
18418 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
18419 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18420 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
18421
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018422table_gpc0(<table>)
18423 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18424 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18425 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18426 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18427 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
18428
18429table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
18430 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18431 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18432 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
18433 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18434 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
18435 sample fetch keyword.
18436
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018437table_gpc1(<table>)
18438 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18439 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18440 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
18441 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18442 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
18443
18444table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
18445 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18446 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18447 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
18448 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18449 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
18450 sample fetch keyword.
18451
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018452table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
18453 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18454 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018455 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018456 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18457 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18458
18459table_http_err_rate(<table>)
18460 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18461 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18462 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
18463 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
18464 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
18465 keyword.
18466
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018467table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
18468 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18469 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18470 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
18471 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
18472 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18473
18474table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
18475 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18476 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18477 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
18478 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
18479 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
18480 keyword.
18481
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018482table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
18483 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18484 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018485 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018486 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
18487 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18488
18489table_http_req_rate(<table>)
18490 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18491 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18492 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
18493 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
18494 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
18495 keyword.
18496
Aurelien DARRAGONfd766dd2022-11-23 14:35:06 +010018497table_idle(<table>[,<default_value>])
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018498 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18499 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18500 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18501 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
18502 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
18503 updated.
18504 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
18505
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018506table_kbytes_in(<table>)
18507 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18508 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018509 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018510 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
18511 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
18512 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
18513 keyword.
18514
18515table_kbytes_out(<table>)
18516 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18517 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018518 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018519 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
18520 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
18521 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
18522 keyword.
18523
18524table_server_id(<table>)
18525 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18526 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18527 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
18528 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
18529 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
18530 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
18531
18532table_sess_cnt(<table>)
18533 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18534 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018535 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018536 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
18537 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
18538 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
18539 keyword.
18540
18541table_sess_rate(<table>)
18542 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18543 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18544 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
18545 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
18546 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
18547 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
18548 keyword.
18549
18550table_trackers(<table>)
18551 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18552 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18553 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18554 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
18555 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
18556 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
18557 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
18558 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
18559 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
18560 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
18561
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018562ub64dec
18563 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
18564 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
18565 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
18566
18567 Example:
18568 # Decoding a JWT payload:
18569 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
18570
18571ub64enc
18572 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
18573
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018574upper
18575 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
18576 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18577 type. The result is of type string.
18578
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020018579url_dec([<in_form>])
18580 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
18581 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
18582 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
18583 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
18584 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
18585 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020018586
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010018587url_enc([<enc_type>])
18588 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
18589 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
18590 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
18591 optional argument is here for future changes.
18592
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018593ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018594 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018595 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
18596 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
18597 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018598 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18599 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18600 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18601 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010018602 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018603 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18604 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018605
18606 Example:
18607 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
18608 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
18609
18610 message Point {
18611 int32 latitude = 1;
18612 int32 longitude = 2;
18613 }
18614
18615 message PPoint {
18616 Point point = 59;
18617 }
18618
18619 message Rectangle {
18620 // One corner of the rectangle.
18621 PPoint lo = 48;
18622 // The other corner of the rectangle.
18623 PPoint hi = 49;
18624 }
18625
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018626 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
18627 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
18628 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018629
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018630 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
18631 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018632 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018633 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
18634
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018635 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018636
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010018637 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018638
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018639 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
18640 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
18641 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018642
18643 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
18644 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
18645 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
18646
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018647 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
18648 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
18649 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018650
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018651
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010018652unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010018653 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
18654 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
18655 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
18656 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18657 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
18658 response),
18659 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18660 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
18661 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
18662 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
18663
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018664utime(<format>[,<offset>])
18665 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18666 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
18667 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18668 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18669 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18670 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
18671
18672 Example :
18673
18674 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018675 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018676 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18677
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018678word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18679 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
18680 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
18681 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018682 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018683 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
18684 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
18685
18686 Example :
18687 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
18688 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18689 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
18690 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
18691 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018692 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010018693
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018694wt6([<avalanche>])
18695 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
18696 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18697 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18698 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18699 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18700 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18701 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018702 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
18703 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018704
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018705xor(<value>)
18706 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018707 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018708 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018709 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018710 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018711 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18712 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018713 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018714 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18715 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018716 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018717 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018718
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010018719xxh3([<seed>])
18720 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
18721 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
18722 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
18723 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
18724 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
18725 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
18726 considered as cryptographically secure.
18727
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010018728xxh32([<seed>])
18729 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
18730 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18731 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18732 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18733 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18734 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18735 as cryptographically secure.
18736
18737xxh64([<seed>])
18738 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
18739 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18740 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18741 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18742 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18743 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18744 as cryptographically secure.
18745
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010018746x509_v_err_str
18747 Convert a numerical value to its corresponding X509_V_ERR constant name. It
18748 is useful in ACL in order to have a configuration which works with multiple
18749 version of OpenSSL since some codes might change when changing version.
18750
18751 The list of constant provided by OpenSSL can be found at
18752 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
18753 Be careful to read the page for the right version of OpenSSL.
18754
18755 Example:
18756
18757 bind :443 ssl crt common.pem ca-file ca-auth.crt verify optional crt-ignore-err X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED,X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
18758
18759 acl cert_expired ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
18760 acl cert_revoked ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED
18761 acl cert_ok ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_OK
18762
18763 http-response add-header X-SSL Ok if cert_ok
18764 http-response add-header X-SSL Expired if cert_expired
18765 http-response add-header X-SSL Revoked if cert_revoked
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018766
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200187677.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018768--------------------------------------------
18769
18770A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
18771not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
18772"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
18773The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
18774
18775always_false : boolean
18776 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18777 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18778
18779always_true : boolean
18780 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18781 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18782
18783avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018784 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018785 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
18786 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
18787 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
18788 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
18789 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
18790 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
18791 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
18792 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
18793 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
18794 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
18795 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
18796 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
18797 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010018798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018799be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018800 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
18801 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
18802 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
18803 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018804 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
18805
18806be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
18807 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18808 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
18809 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
18810 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
18811 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018812 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
18813 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018814
18815 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
18816 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
18817 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018819be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
18820 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18821 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18822 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018823 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018824 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
18825 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018826
18827 Example :
18828 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
18829 backend dynamic
18830 mode http
18831 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
18832 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018833
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018834bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018835 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
18836 of the string.
18837
18838bool(<bool>) : bool
18839 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
18840 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
18841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018842connslots([<backend>]) : integer
18843 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018844 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018845 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
18846 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050018847
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018848 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018849 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018850 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
18851
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018852 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
18853 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018854
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018855 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018856 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018857 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018858 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018859 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018860 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018861 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018862
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018863 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
18864 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018865 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018866 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018867
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018868cpu_calls : integer
18869 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
18870 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
18871 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
18872 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
18873 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
18874 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
18875
18876cpu_ns_avg : integer
18877 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18878 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18879 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18880 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18881 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18882 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18883 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
18884 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
18885 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
18886 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
18887 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
18888
18889cpu_ns_tot : integer
18890 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18891 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18892 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18893 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18894 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18895 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18896 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
18897 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
18898 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
18899 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
18900 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
18901 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
18902 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
18903
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018904date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018905 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018906
18907 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
18908 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
18909 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018910 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
18911
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018912 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
18913 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
18914 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
18915 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
18916 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
18917
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018918 Example :
18919
18920 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
18921 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018922
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018923 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
18924 # millisecond granularity
18925 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
18926
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010018927date_us : integer
18928 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
18929 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
18930 from the same timeval structure.
18931
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018932env(<name>) : string
18933 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
18934 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
18935 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
18936 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
18937 certain way.
18938
18939 Examples :
18940 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
18941 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
18942
18943 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018944 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018946fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
18947 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018948 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
18949 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018950 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
18951 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018952 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018953 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
18954 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018955
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020018956fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18957 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
18958 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
18959 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
18960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018961fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18962 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18963 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18964 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
18965 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
18966 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
18967 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
18968 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
18969 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018970
18971 Example :
18972 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
18973 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
18974 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
18975 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
18976 frontend mail
18977 bind :25
18978 mode tcp
18979 maxconn 100
18980 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
18981 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
18982 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
18983 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018984
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010018985hostname : string
18986 Returns the system hostname.
18987
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018988int(<integer>) : signed integer
18989 Returns a signed integer.
18990
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018991ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
18992 Returns an ipv4.
18993
18994ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
18995 Returns an ipv6.
18996
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020018997last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018998 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
18999 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
19000 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19001 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19002 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19003 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19004 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19005 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19006 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19007 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19008 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19009 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
19010
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019011last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019012 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
19013 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
19014 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19015 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19016 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19017 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19018 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19019 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19020 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19021 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19022 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19023 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
19024
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019025lat_ns_avg : integer
19026 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19027 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19028 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19029 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19030 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19031 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19032 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19033 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19034 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019035 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19036 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19037 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19038 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19039 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
19040 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019041
19042lat_ns_tot : integer
19043 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19044 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19045 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19046 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19047 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19048 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19049 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19050 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19051 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019052 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19053 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19054 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19055 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19056 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019057 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
19058 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
19059 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
19060 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
19061 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
19062 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
19063
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019064meth(<method>) : method
19065 Returns a method.
19066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019067nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
19068 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
19069 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
19070 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019071 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
19072 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
19073 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019074
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040019075prio_class : integer
19076 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
19077 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
19078 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
19079
19080prio_offset : integer
19081 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
19082 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
19083 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
19084 set-priority-offset".
19085
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019086proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020019087 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
19088 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019090queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019091 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
19092 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
19093 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019094 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
19095 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
19096 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
19097 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
19098 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
19099
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019100quic_enabled : boolean
19101 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
19102 change without deprecation in the future.
19103
19104 Return true when the support for QUIC transport protocol was compiled and
19105 if this procotol was not disabled by "no-quic" global option. See also "no-quic"
19106 global option.
19107
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010019108rand([<range>]) : integer
19109 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
19110 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
19111 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
19112 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
19113 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
19114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019115srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19116 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19117 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
19118 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
19119 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
19120 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019121 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
19122 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
19123
19124srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19125 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19126 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
19127 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19128 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
19129 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
19130 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
19131 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
19132
19133 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
19134 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019135
19136srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
19137 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
19138 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
19139 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019140 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019141 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
19142 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
19143 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
19144
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020019145srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19146 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
19147 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19148 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
19149 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
19150 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
19151 fetch methods.
19152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019153srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19154 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19155 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019156 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019157 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
19158 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019159 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019160 overloading servers).
19161
19162 Example :
19163 # Redirect to a separate back
19164 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
19165 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
19166 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
19167
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019168srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019169 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
19170 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
19171 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
19172
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019173srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019174 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
19175 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19176 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
19177
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019178srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019179 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
19180 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19181 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
19182
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019183stopping : boolean
19184 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
19185 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
19186 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
19187
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019188str(<string>) : string
19189 Returns a string.
19190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019191table_avl([<table>]) : integer
19192 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
19193 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
19194
19195table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19196 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
19197 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
19198 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
19199
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010019200thread : integer
19201 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
19202 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
19203 and debugging purposes.
19204
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020019205uuid([<version>]) : string
19206 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
19207 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
19208 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
19209
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019210var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019211 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019212 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
19213 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
19214 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019215 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019216 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19217 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019218 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019219 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19220 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019221 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019222 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019223
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192247.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019225----------------------------------
19226
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019227The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019228closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
19229methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
19230sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
19231TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019232the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
19233counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020019234"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +010019235used if the global "tune.stick-counters" value does not exceed 3, otherwise the
19236counter number can be specified as the first integer argument when using the
19237"sc_" prefix starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (tune.stick-counters-1).
19238An optional table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the
19239currently tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of
19240the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019241
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019242bc_dst : ip
19243 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
19244 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
19245 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
19246 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19247
19248bc_dst_port : integer
19249 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019250 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019251
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019252bc_err : integer
19253 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
19254 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
19255 and their corresponding error message.
19256
19257bc_err_str : string
19258 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
19259 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
19260 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
19261 corresponding error message.
19262
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010019263bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010019264 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19265 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19266 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
19267
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019268bc_src : ip
19269 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019270 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019271 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19272 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19273
19274bc_src_port : integer
19275 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019276 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019278be_id : integer
19279 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019280 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19281 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019282
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019283be_name : string
19284 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019285 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19286 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019287
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010019288be_server_timeout : integer
19289 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
19290 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19291 also the "cur_server_timeout".
19292
19293be_tunnel_timeout : integer
19294 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
19295 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19296 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
19297
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010019298cur_server_timeout : integer
19299 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19300 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
19301 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
19302
19303cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
19304 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19305 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
19306 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
19307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019308dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019309 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
19310 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
19311 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
19312 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
19313 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
19314 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
19315 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
19316 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
19317 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
19318 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
19319 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019320
19321dst_conn : integer
19322 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19323 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
19324 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
19325 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
19326 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
19327 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
19328 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
19329 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019330
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019331dst_is_local : boolean
19332 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
19333 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
19334 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
19335 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019336 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019337 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
19338 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
19339 it only once per connection.
19340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019341dst_port : integer
19342 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
19343 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019344 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
19345 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
19346 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
19347 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019348
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019349fc_dst : ip
19350 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19351 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
19352 for details.
19353
19354fc_dst_is_local : boolean
19355 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
19356 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
19357 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
19358
19359fc_dst_port : integer
19360 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
19361 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
19362 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
19363
19364fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019365 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
19366 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
19367 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019368 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019369 error codes and their corresponding error message.
19370
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019371fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050019372 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019373 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019374 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019375 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
19376
19377 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19378 | ID | message |
19379 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19380 | 0 | "Success" |
19381 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
19382 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
19383 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
19384 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
19385 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
19386 | 6 | "General socket error" |
19387 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
19388 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
19389 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
19390 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
19391 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19392 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19393 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19394 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
19395 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
19396 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
19397 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
19398 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19399 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19400 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
19401 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
19402 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
19403 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
19404 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
19405 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
19406 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
19407 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
19408 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
19409 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
19410 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
19411 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
19412 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
19413 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
19414 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
19415 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
19416 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
19417 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
19418 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
19419 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
19420 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
19421 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
19422 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020019423 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019424 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19425
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019426fc_fackets : integer
19427 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
19428 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19429 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19430 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19431
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020019432fc_http_major : integer
19433 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19434 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19435 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
19436
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019437fc_lost : integer
19438 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
19439 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19440 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19441 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19442
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020019443fc_pp_authority : string
19444 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19445 if any.
19446
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010019447fc_pp_unique_id : string
19448 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19449 if any.
19450
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010019451fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
19452 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
19453 header.
19454
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019455fc_reordering : integer
19456 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
19457 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19458 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19459 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19460
19461fc_retrans : integer
19462 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
19463 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19464 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19465 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19466
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020019467fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
19468 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
19469 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
19470 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
19471 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19472 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19473 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19474
19475fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
19476 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
19477 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
19478 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
19479 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19480 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19481 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19482
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020019483fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019484 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
19485 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
19486 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
19487 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19488
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019489fc_src : ip
19490 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19491 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
19492 for details.
19493
19494fc_src_is_local : boolean
19495 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
19496 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
19497 "src_is_local" for details.
19498
19499fc_src_port : integer
19500
19501 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
19502 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
19503 this address. See "src-port" for details.
19504
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019505
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019506fc_unacked : integer
19507 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
19508 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
19509 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
19510 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019511
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020019512fe_defbe : string
19513 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
19514 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
19515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019516fe_id : integer
19517 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010019518 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019519 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
19520
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019521fe_name : string
19522 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
19523 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
19524 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
19525
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010019526fe_client_timeout : integer
19527 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
19528 current frontend.
19529
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019530sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019531sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19532sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19533sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019534 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
19535 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
19536 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
19537
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019538sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019539sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19540sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19541sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019542 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
19543 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
19544 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
19545
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019546sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19547 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19548 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19549 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19550 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19551 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19552 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19553 will always return zero.
19554 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19555 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19556
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019557sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019558sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19559sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19560sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019561 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
19562 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019563 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
19564 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
19565 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019566
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019567 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019568 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19569 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019570 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19571 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
19572 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019573 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19574 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19575
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019576sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19577sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19578sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19579sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19580 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
19581 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
19582 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
19583 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
19584 when a first ACL was verified.
19585
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019586sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019587sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19588sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19589sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019590 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019591 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
19592
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019593sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019594sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
19595sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
19596sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019597 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19598 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
19599 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
19600
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019601sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019602sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19603sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19604sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019605 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
19606 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
19607 See also src_conn_rate.
19608
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019609sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19610 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
19611 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
19612 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
19613 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19614 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
19615 index, zero is returned.
19616 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19617 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
19618
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019619sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019620sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19621sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19622sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019623 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019624 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019625
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019626sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19627sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19628sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19629sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19630 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19631 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
19632
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019633sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19634 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19635 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
19636 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19637 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19638 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
19639 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
19640 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
19641
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019642sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19643sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19644sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19645sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19646 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19647 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
19648
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019649sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19650 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19651 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
19652 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
19653 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
19654 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
19655 between 0 and 2.
19656 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
19657 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19658 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19659 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19660 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19661
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019662sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019663sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
19664sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
19665sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019666 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
19667 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19668 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019669 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19670 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19671 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019672
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019673sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19674sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19675sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19676sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19677 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19678 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19679 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19680 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19681 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19682 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19683
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019684sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019685sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19686sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19687sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019688 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019689 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
19690 See also src_http_err_cnt.
19691
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019692sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019693sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19694sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19695sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019696 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
19697 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19698 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
19699 src_http_err_rate.
19700
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019701sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19702sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19703sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19704sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19705 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
19706 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
19707 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
19708
19709sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19710sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19711sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19712sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19713 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
19714 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
19715 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
19716 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
19717
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019718sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019719sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19720sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19721sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019722 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019723 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19724 src_http_req_cnt.
19725
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019726sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019727sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19728sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19729sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019730 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
19731 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
19732 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19733 src_http_req_rate.
19734
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019735sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19736 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19737 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19738 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19739 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19740 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19741 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19742 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
19743 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19744 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19745
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019746sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019747sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19748sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19749sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019750 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019751 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19752 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19753 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19754 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019755
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019756 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019757 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19758 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019759 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19760
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019761sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19762sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19763sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19764sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19765 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
19766 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19767 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19768 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19769 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
19770
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019771sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019772sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19773sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19774sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019775 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
19776 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19777 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019778
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019779sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019780sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19781sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19782sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019783 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
19784 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19785 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019786
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019787sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019788sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19789sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19790sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019791 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019792 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
19793 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
19794 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019795 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019796 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
19797
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019798sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019799sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19800sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19801sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019802 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
19803 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19804 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
19805 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
19806 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019807 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019808
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019809sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019810sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19811sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19812sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020019813 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
19814 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
19815 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
19816
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019817sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019818sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19819sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19820sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019821 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19822 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019823 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019824 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
19825 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019826 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
19827 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
19828 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019830so_id : integer
19831 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
19832 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
19833 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019834
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010019835so_name : string
19836 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
19837 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
19838 strings instead of integers.
19839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019840src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019841 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
19842 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
19843 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19844 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
19845 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
19846 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
19847 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
19848 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
19849 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
19850 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
19851 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
19852 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
19853 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
19854 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
19855 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019856
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019857 Example:
19858 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
19859 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
19860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019861src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19862 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
19863 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
19864 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019865 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019867src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19868 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
19869 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019870 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019871 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019872
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019873src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19874 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19875 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19876 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
19877 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19878 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
19879 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19880 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19881 See also sc_clr_gpc.
19882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019883src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19884 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19885 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19886 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19887 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19888 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19889 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019890
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019891 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019892 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19893 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
19894 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
19895 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019896 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019897 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19898 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19899
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019900src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19901 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19902 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19903 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19904 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19905 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19906 was verified.
19907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019908src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019909 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019910 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019911 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019912 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019914src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019915 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019916 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19917 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019918 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019920src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19921 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
19922 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19923 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019924 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019925
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019926src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19927 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
19928 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19929 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19930 is an integer between 0 and 99.
19931 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
19932 is returned.
19933 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
19934 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19935 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
19936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019937src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019938 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019939 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019940 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019941 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019942
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019943src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19944 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19945 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19946 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19947 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
19948
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019949src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19950 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19951 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19952 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
19953 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19954 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
19955 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
19956
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019957src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19958 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19959 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19960 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19961 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
19962
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019963src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19964 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19965 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
19966 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19967 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
19968 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19969 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
19970 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19971 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19972 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19973 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019975src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019976 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019977 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019978 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19979 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019980 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19981 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19982 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019983
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019984src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19985 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19986 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19987 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19988 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19989 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19990 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19991 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019993src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019994 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019995 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019996 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019997 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019998 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020000src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20001 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
20002 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20003 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20004 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020005 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020006
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020007src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20008 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
20009 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050020010 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020011 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
20012 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20013
20014src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20015 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
20016 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20017 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
20018 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
20019 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
20020 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
20021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020022src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020023 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020024 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20025 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020026 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020028src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20029 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
20030 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20031 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020032 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020033 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020034
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020035src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20036 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
20037 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20038 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
20039 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20040 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
20041 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20042 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20043 See also sc_inc_gpc.
20044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020045src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20046 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20047 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20048 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020049 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020050 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20051 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020052
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020053 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020054 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020055 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020056 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020057
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020058src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20059 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20060 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20061 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
20062 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20063 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20064 connection when a first ACL was verified.
20065
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020066src_is_local : boolean
20067 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
20068 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
20069 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
20070 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020071 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020072 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
20073 once per connection.
20074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020075src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020076 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
20077 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20078 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
20079 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
20080 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020082src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020083 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
20084 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20085 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
20086 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
20087 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020089src_port : integer
20090 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020091 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
20092 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
20093 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
20094 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010020095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020096src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020097 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020098 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20099 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
20100 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020101 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020103src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20104 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
20105 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20106 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20107 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020108 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020110src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20111 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
20112 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
20113 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
20114 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
20115 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
20116 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
20117 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
20118 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020119
20120 Example :
20121 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
20122 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
20123 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
20124 listen ssh
20125 bind :22
20126 mode tcp
20127 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020128 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020129 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020130 server local 127.0.0.1:22
20131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020132srv_id : integer
20133 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
20134 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020135 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020020136
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020137srv_name : string
20138 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
20139 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020140 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020141
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200201427.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020143----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020020144
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020145The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020146closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
20147when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
20148usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020149future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020150
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00002015151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
20152 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
20153 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
20154 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
20155 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
20156 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
20157
20158 Example :
20159 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
20160 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
20161 # the request.
20162 frontend http-in
20163 bind *:8081
20164 default_backend servers
20165 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
20166 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
20167
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020168ssl_bc : boolean
20169 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20170 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020171 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20172 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020173
20174ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
20175 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020176 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20177 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020178
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020179ssl_bc_alpn : string
20180 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
20181 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020182 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020183 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20184 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20185 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
20186 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
20187 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020188 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
20189 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020190
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020191ssl_bc_cipher : string
20192 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020193 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20194 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020195
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020196ssl_bc_client_random : binary
20197 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20198 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20199 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020200 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020201
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020202ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020203 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020204 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20205 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
20206 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
20207 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020208 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
20209 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
20210 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
20211
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020212ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020213 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020214 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20215 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
20216 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020217
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020218ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
20219 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20220 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020221 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20222 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020223
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020224ssl_bc_npn : string
20225 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
20226 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020227 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020228 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
20229 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
20230 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
20231 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020232 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
20233 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020234
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020235ssl_bc_protocol : string
20236 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020237 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20238 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020239
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020240ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020241 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020242 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020243 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
20244 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020245
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020246ssl_bc_server_random : binary
20247 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20248 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20249 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020250 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020251
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020252ssl_bc_session_id : binary
20253 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
20254 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020255 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20256 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020257
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020258ssl_bc_session_key : binary
20259 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
20260 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20261 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020262 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020263
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020264ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
20265 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020266 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20267 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020269ssl_c_ca_err : integer
20270 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20271 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
20272 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
20273 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
20274 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020276ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
20277 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20278 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
20279 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
20280 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020281
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020282ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020283 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
20284 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20285 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020286 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020287 does not support resumed sessions.
20288
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020289ssl_c_der : binary
20290 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
20291 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20292 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020294ssl_c_err : integer
20295 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20296 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
20297 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
20298 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20299 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020300
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020301ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020302 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20303 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20304 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20305 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20306 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20307 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20308 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20309 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020310 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20311 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20312 LDAP v3.
20313 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20314 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020316ssl_c_key_alg : string
20317 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20318 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20319 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020321ssl_c_notafter : string
20322 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
20323 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20324 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020020325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020326ssl_c_notbefore : string
20327 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
20328 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20329 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020330
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020331ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020332 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20333 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20334 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20335 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20336 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20337 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20338 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20339 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020340 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20341 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20342 LDAP v3.
20343 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20344 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020346ssl_c_serial : binary
20347 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
20348 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20349 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020351ssl_c_sha1 : binary
20352 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
20353 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
20354 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020355 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
20356 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
20357
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020358 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020359 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020361ssl_c_sig_alg : string
20362 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20363 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20364 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020366ssl_c_used : boolean
20367 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
20368 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020370ssl_c_verify : integer
20371 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
20372 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
20373 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
20374 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020376ssl_c_version : integer
20377 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
20378 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020379
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010020380ssl_f_der : binary
20381 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
20382 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20383 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20384
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020385ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020386 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20387 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20388 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20389 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020390 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020391 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20392 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20393 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020394 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20395 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20396 LDAP v3.
20397 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20398 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020400ssl_f_key_alg : string
20401 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20402 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
20403 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020405ssl_f_notafter : string
20406 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20407 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20408 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020410ssl_f_notbefore : string
20411 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20412 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20413 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020414
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020415ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020416 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20417 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20418 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20419 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20420 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20421 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20422 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20423 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020424 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20425 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20426 LDAP v3.
20427 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20428 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020430ssl_f_serial : binary
20431 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20432 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20433 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020434
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020020435ssl_f_sha1 : binary
20436 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
20437 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20438 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020440ssl_f_sig_alg : string
20441 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20442 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20443 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020445ssl_f_version : integer
20446 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20447 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
20448
20449ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020450 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20451 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
20452 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
20453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020454 Example :
20455 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
20456 listen http-https
20457 bind :80
20458 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
20459 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
20460
20461ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
20462 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
20463 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
20464
20465ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020466 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020467 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020468 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020469 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20470 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20471 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
20472 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
20473 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
20474 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
20475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020476ssl_fc_cipher : string
20477 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
20478 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020020479
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020480ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20481 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
20482 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020483 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020484 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20485 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20486 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020487
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020488 Example:
20489 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20490 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20491 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20492 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20493 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20494 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20495 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20496 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20497 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20498
20499ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020500 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020501 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020502 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
20503 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020504 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20505 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020506
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020507ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020508 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020509 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020510 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020511 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20512 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20513 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20514 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
20515 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
20516 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020517
20518ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020519 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020520 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
20521 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020522
20523ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
20524 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
20525 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020526 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020527
20528 Example:
20529 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20530 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20531 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20532 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20533 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20534 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20535 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20536 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20537 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20538
20539ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20540 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
20541 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020542 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020543 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20544 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
20545 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20546
20547 Example:
20548 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20549 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20550 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20551 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20552 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20553 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20554 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20555 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20556 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20557
20558ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20559 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
20560 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020561 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020562 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20563 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
20564 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20565
20566 Example:
20567 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20568 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20569 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20570 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20571 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20572 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20573 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20574 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20575 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020576
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020577ssl_fc_client_random : binary
20578 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20579 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20580 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20581
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020582ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
20583 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20584 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20585 transport layer.
20586 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20587 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20588 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20589 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20590
20591ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20592 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20593 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20594 transport layer.
20595 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20596 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20597 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20598 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20599
20600ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
20601 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20602 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20603 transport layer.
20604 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20605 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20606 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20607 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20608
20609ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
20610 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20611 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20612 transport layer.
20613 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20614 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20615 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20616 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20617
20618ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
20619 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20620 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20621 transport layer.
20622 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20623 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20624 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20625 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20626
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020627ssl_fc_err : integer
20628 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20629 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20630 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
20631 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
20632 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
20633 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
20634 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
20635 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
20636 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
20637 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
20638 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
20639 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20640 codes.
20641
20642ssl_fc_err_str : string
20643 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20644 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20645 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
20646 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
20647 also "ssl_fc_err".
20648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020649ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020650 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
20651 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010020652 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
20653 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
20654 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
20655 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020656
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020020657ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
20658 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
20659 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
20660 wait until the handshake happened.
20661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020662ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
20663 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020020664 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
20665 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020666 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020020667 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020668
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020020669ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020020670 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010020671 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
20672 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020020673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020674ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020675 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020676 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020677 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
20678 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
20679 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
20680 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
20681 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
20682 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020020683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020684ssl_fc_protocol : string
20685 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
20686 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020687
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020688ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
20689 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
20690 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020691 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
20692 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020693
20694 Example:
20695 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20696 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20697 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20698 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20699 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20700 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20701 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20702 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20703 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20704
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020705ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020706 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020707 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010020708 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020709
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020710ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20711 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20712 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20713 transport layer.
20714 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20715 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20716 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20717 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20718
20719ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
20720 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20721 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20722 transport layer.
20723 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20724 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20725 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20726 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20727
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020728ssl_fc_server_random : binary
20729 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20730 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20731 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020733ssl_fc_session_id : binary
20734 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
20735 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
20736 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
20737 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020738
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020739ssl_fc_session_key : binary
20740 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
20741 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20742 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
20743 BoringSSL.
20744
20745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020746ssl_fc_sni : string
20747 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
20748 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020749 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020750 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
20751 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
20752
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020753 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020754 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020755 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020756 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020020757 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020758
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010020759 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
20760 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
20761 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
20762 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
20763 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
20764 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
20765 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
20766 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
20767 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
20768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020769 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020770 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
20771 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020020772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020773ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
20774 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
20775 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020776
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020777ssl_s_der : binary
20778 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
20779 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20780 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20781
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020782ssl_s_chain_der : binary
20783 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
20784 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20785 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020786 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020787 does not support resumed sessions.
20788
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020789ssl_s_key_alg : string
20790 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20791 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
20792 SSL/TLS transport layer.
20793
20794ssl_s_notafter : string
20795 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
20796 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20797 transport layer.
20798
20799ssl_s_notbefore : string
20800 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
20801 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20802 transport layer.
20803
20804ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20805 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20806 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20807 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20808 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20809 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20810 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020811 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20812 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020813 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20814 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20815 LDAP v3.
20816 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20817 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20818
20819ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20820 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20821 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20822 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20823 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20824 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20825 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020826 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20827 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020828 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20829 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20830 LDAP v3.
20831 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20832 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20833
20834ssl_s_serial : binary
20835 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
20836 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20837 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20838
20839ssl_s_sha1 : binary
20840 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
20841 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20842 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20843
20844ssl_s_sig_alg : string
20845 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20846 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20847 layer.
20848
20849ssl_s_version : integer
20850 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
20851 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020852
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200208537.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020854------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020856Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
20857sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
20858only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
20859For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
20860be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
20861can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
20862sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
20863for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
20864content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020865
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010020866Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
20867 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020868 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010020869 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
20870 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
20871 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
20872 sample expression). So be careful.
20873
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010020874distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
20875 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
20876 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
20877 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
20878 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
20879 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
20880 list of supported tokens.
20881
20882distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
20883 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
20884 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
20885 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
20886 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
20887 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
20888 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
20889 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
20890 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
20891 supported tokens.
20892
20893 Example :
20894 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
20895 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
20896 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
20897 # send large files to the big farm
20898 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
20899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020900payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020901 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020902 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
20903 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020905payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
20906 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020907 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020908 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020910req.len : integer
20911req_len : integer (deprecated)
20912 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20913 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20914 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20915 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20916 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020917 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020918 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
20919 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020921req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20922 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020923 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
20924 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
20925 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
20926 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020927
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020928 ACL derivatives :
20929 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020931req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20932 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20933 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20934 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
20935 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020936
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020937 ACL derivatives :
20938 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020940 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020942req.proto_http : boolean
20943req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
20944 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
20945 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
20946 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
20947 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
20948 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
20949 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
20950 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020952 Example:
20953 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
20954 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20955 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020956 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020958req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
20959rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20960 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
20961 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
20962 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
20963 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
20964 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
20965 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
20966 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020968 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
20969 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
20970 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
20971 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
20972 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
20973 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020975 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020976 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020978 Example :
20979 listen tse-farm
20980 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
20981 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
20982 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
20983 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
20984 # apply RDP cookie persistence
20985 persist rdp-cookie
20986 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
20987 # This is only useful makes sense if
20988 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
20989 stick-table type string size 204800
20990 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
20991 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
20992 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020994 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020995 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020997req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
20998rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
20999 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
21000 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
21001 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
21002 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021004 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021005 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021006
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021007req.ssl_alpn : string
21008 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
21009 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
21010 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
21011 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
21012 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
21013 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021014 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021015
21016 Examples :
21017 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21018 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021019 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021020 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021021 default_backend bk_default
21022
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021023req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
21024 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
21025 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020021026 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
21027 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
21028 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
21029 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
21030 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021032req.ssl_hello_type : integer
21033req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21034 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21035 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
21036 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21037 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21038 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
21039 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21040 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021042req.ssl_sni : string
21043req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
21044 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
21045 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
21046 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
21047 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21048 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020021049 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
21050 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
21051 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
21052 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
21053 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
21054 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
21055 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
21056 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
21057 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021059 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021060 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021062 Examples :
21063 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21064 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021065 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021066 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021067 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021068
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053021069req.ssl_st_ext : integer
21070 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
21071 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
21072 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
21073 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
21074 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
21075 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
21076 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
21077 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
21078 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
21079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021080req.ssl_ver : integer
21081req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
21082 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
21083 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
21084 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
21085 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
21086 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21087 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
21088 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021089 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021090 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021092 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021093 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021094
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021095res.len : integer
21096 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21097 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21098 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21099 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21100 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021101 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021102 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021103 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021105res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21106 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021107 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021108 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021109 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021110 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021112res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21113 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21114 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21115 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021116 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
21117 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021119 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021120
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020021121res.ssl_hello_type : integer
21122rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21123 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21124 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
21125 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21126 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21127 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
21128 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21129 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
21130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021131wait_end : boolean
21132 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
21133 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021134 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021135 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
21136 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021137 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021138 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
21139 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021141 Examples :
21142 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
21143 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
21144 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021146 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
21147 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21148 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
21149 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
21150 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
21151 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
21152 tcp-request content reject
21153
21154
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200211557.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021156--------------------------------------
21157
21158It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
21159This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
21160data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
21161its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
21162HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
21163content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
21164to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
21165more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
21166response are indexed.
21167
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010021168Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
21169 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
21170 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
21171 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
21172 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
21173 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
21174 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
21175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021176base : string
21177 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21178 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
21179 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
21180 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
21181 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
21182 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
21183 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
21184 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
21185
21186 ACL derivatives :
21187 base : exact string match
21188 base_beg : prefix match
21189 base_dir : subdir match
21190 base_dom : domain match
21191 base_end : suffix match
21192 base_len : length match
21193 base_reg : regex match
21194 base_sub : substring match
21195
21196base32 : integer
21197 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
21198 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
21199 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020021200 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
21201 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
21202 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021203
21204base32+src : binary
21205 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
21206 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
21207 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
21208 per-URL counters.
21209
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010021210baseq : string
21211 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21212 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
21213 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
21214 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
21215
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021216capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
21217 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
21218 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21219 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
21220
21221capture.req.method : string
21222 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
21223 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
21224 because it's allocated.
21225
21226capture.req.uri : string
21227 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
21228 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
21229 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
21230 allocated.
21231
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021232capture.req.ver : string
21233 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21234 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
21235 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
21236
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021237capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
21238 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
21239 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21240 The first entry is an index of 0.
21241 See also: "capture response header"
21242
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021243capture.res.ver : string
21244 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21245 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
21246 persistent flag.
21247
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021248req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021249 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
21250 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
21251 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021252
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020021253req.body_param([<name>) : string
21254 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
21255 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
21256 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
21257 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
21258 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
21259 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
21260 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
21261 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
21262 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
21263 given.
21264
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021265req.body_len : integer
21266 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
21267 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021268 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
21269 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021270
21271req.body_size : integer
21272 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021273 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21274 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021276req.cook([<name>]) : string
21277cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21278 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21279 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
21280 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
21281 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
21282 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
21283 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
21284 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
21285 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
21286
21287 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021288 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
21289 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
21290 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
21291 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
21292 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
21293 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
21294 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
21295 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021297req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21298cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21299 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21300 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021302req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21303cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21304 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21305 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
21306 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
21307 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021309cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21310 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21311 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
21312 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
21313 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021314 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021315 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
21316 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
21317 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
21318 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021320hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21321 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
21322 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
21323 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
21324 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021325 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021327req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021328 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
21329 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
21330 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
21331 with headers such as User-Agent.
21332
21333 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21334 found.
21335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021336 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21337 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21338 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021339 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021341req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21342 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21343 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021344 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
21345 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021347req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021348 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
21349 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
21350 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
21351 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
21352 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
21353 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
21354 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
21355
21356 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21357 found.
21358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021359 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21360 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21361 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021362 with -1 being the last one.
21363
21364 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
21365 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021367 ACL derivatives :
21368 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21369 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21370 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21371 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21372 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21373 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21374 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21375 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
21376
21377req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21378hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
21379 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21380 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021381 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
21382 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
21383 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
21384
21385 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
21386 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
21387 which contain more than one of certain headers.
21388
21389 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021390
21391req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21392hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
21393 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
21394 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
21395 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010021396 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
21397 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
21398 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
21399 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
21400 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021401
21402 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21403
21404 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021405
21406req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21407hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
21408 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
21409 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
21410 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021411
21412 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21413
21414 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021415
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021416req.hdrs : string
21417 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
21418 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21419 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
21420 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21421
21422req.hdrs_bin : binary
21423 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21424 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
21425 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
21426 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
21427 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
21428 names and values (length of 0 for both).
21429
21430 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021431
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021432 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21433 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021435http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
21436 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
21437 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
21438 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
21439 basic auth is supported.
21440
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020021441http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
21442 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
21443 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
21444 performed on the data sent by the client.
21445 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
21446 Authorization one.
21447
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010021448http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
21449 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
21450 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
21451 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
21452 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021453 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
21454 basic auth is supported.
21455
21456 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010021457 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
21458 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
21459 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
21460 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021461
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021462http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021463 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
21464 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
21465 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021466
21467http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021468 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
21469 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
21470 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021471
21472http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021473 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
21474 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
21475 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021477http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020021478 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
21479 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021480 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
21481 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020021482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021483method : integer + string
21484 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
21485 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
21486 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
21487 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
21488 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
21489 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
21490 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021492 ACL derivatives :
21493 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021495 Example :
21496 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
21497 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
21498 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021500path : string
21501 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
21502 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
21503 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
21504 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
21505 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021506 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021507 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021509 ACL derivatives :
21510 path : exact string match
21511 path_beg : prefix match
21512 path_dir : subdir match
21513 path_dom : domain match
21514 path_end : suffix match
21515 path_len : length match
21516 path_reg : regex match
21517 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021518
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020021519pathq : string
21520 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
21521 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
21522 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
21523 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
21524 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
21525 result in both cases.
21526
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010021527query : string
21528 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
21529 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
21530 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
21531 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021532 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010021533 which stops before the question mark.
21534
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021535req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
21536 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
21537 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
21538 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
21539 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
21540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021541req.ver : string
21542req_ver : string (deprecated)
21543 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
21544 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
21545 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021547 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021548 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021549
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021550res.body : binary
21551 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
21552 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021553 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21554
21555 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021556
21557res.body_len : integer
21558 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
21559 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021560 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21561
21562 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021563
21564res.body_size : integer
21565 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
21566 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21567 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
21568 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021569 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21570
21571 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021572
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010021573res.cache_hit : boolean
21574 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
21575 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
21576
21577res.cache_name : string
21578 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
21579 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
21580 empty string.
21581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021582res.comp : boolean
21583 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
21584 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
21585 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021587res.comp_algo : string
21588 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
21589 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
21590 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021592res.cook([<name>]) : string
21593scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21594 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21595 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021596 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
21597
21598 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020021599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021600 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021601 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020021602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021603res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21604scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21605 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21606 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021607 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
21608
21609 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021611res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21612scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21613 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21614 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021615 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
21616
21617 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021619res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021620 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
21621 on the headers within an HTTP response.
21622
21623 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
21624 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
21625
21626 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
21627
21628 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021630res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021631 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
21632 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21633
21634 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
21635 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
21636
21637 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021639res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21640shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021641 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
21642 on the headers within an HTTP response.
21643
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050021644 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021645 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
21646
21647 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021649 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021650 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21651 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21652 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21653 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21654 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21655 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21656 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21657 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021658
21659res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21660shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021661 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
21662 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21663
21664 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050021665 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021666
21667 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021669res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21670shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021671 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
21672 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21673
21674 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21675
21676 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021677
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021678res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
21679 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
21680 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
21681 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021682 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
21683
21684 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021686res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21687shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021688 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
21689 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21690
21691 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21692
21693 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021694
21695res.hdrs : string
21696 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
21697 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21698 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021699 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21700
21701 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021702
21703res.hdrs_bin : binary
21704 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21705 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
21706 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
21707 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
21708 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
21709 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
21710 (length of 0 for both).
21711
21712 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
21713
21714 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21715 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021717res.ver : string
21718resp_ver : string (deprecated)
21719 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021720 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
21721
21722 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021724 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021725 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021727set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21728 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21729 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021730 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021731 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021733 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
21734 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021736status : integer
21737 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
21738 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021739 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
21740
21741 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021742
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020021743unique-id : string
21744 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
21745 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
21746 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
21747 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
21748 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
21749 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
21750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021751url : string
21752 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
21753 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
21754 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
21755 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
21756 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
21757 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
21758 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021760 ACL derivatives :
21761 url : exact string match
21762 url_beg : prefix match
21763 url_dir : subdir match
21764 url_dom : domain match
21765 url_end : suffix match
21766 url_len : length match
21767 url_reg : regex match
21768 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021770url_ip : ip
21771 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
21772 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
21773 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
21774 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021775 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
21776 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021778url_port : integer
21779 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021780 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021781
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021782urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
21783url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021784 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
21785 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021786 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
21787 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
21788 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
21789 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021790 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
21791 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021792 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
21793 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021795 ACL derivatives :
21796 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
21797 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
21798 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
21799 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
21800 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
21801 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
21802 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
21803 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021804
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021806 Example :
21807 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
21808 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
21809 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
21810 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021811
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030021812urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021813 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
21814 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
21815 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020021816
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020021817url32 : integer
21818 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
21819 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
21820 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
21821 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
21822 is an unsigned integer.
21823
21824url32+src : binary
21825 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
21826 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
21827 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
21828
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020021829
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200218307.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021831---------------------------------------
21832
21833This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
21834used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
21835purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
21836There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
21837or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
21838any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
21839for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
21840
21841internal.htx.data : integer
21842 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
21843 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21844
21845internal.htx.free : integer
21846 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
21847 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21848
21849internal.htx.free_data : integer
21850 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
21851 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21852
21853internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010021854 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
21855 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
21856 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021857
21858internal.htx.nbblks : integer
21859 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
21860 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21861
21862internal.htx.size : integer
21863 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
21864 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21865
21866internal.htx.used : integer
21867 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
21868 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21869 direction.
21870
21871internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
21872 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21873 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
21874 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
21875 of the special value :
21876 * head : The oldest inserted block
21877 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021878 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021879
21880internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
21881 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21882 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
21883 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
21884 integer or one of the special value :
21885 * head : The oldest inserted block
21886 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021887 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021888
21889internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
21890 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21891 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
21892 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21893 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21894
21895 * head : The oldest inserted block
21896 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021897 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021898
21899internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
21900 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21901 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21902 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21903 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21904
21905 * head : The oldest inserted block
21906 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021907 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021908
21909internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
21910 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21911 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21912 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21913 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21914
21915 * head : The oldest inserted block
21916 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021917 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021918
21919internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
21920 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
21921 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
21922 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21923 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21924
21925 * head : The oldest inserted block
21926 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021927 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021928
21929internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
21930 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
21931 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
21932 it returns false.
21933
21934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200219357.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021936---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021938Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
21939every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020021940order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021942ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021943---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
21944FALSE always_false never match
21945HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
21946HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
21947HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010021948HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021949HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
21950HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
21951HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
21952HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020021953LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021954METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
21955METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
21956METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
21957METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
21958METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
21959METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
21960METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
21961METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
21962RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
21963REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
21964TRUE always_true always match
21965WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
21966---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021967
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010021968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219698. Logging
21970----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021971
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021972One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
21973provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
21974very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
21975provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
21976state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021977to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021978headers.
21979
21980In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
21981about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
21982send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
21983
21984 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
21985 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
21986 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
21987 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
21988 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021989 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060021990 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021991
21992The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
21993allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
21994as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
21995while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
21996real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
21997delay.
21998
21999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220008.1. Log levels
22001---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022002
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022003TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022004source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022005HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
22006in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
22007track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
22008syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
22009about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022010
22011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220128.2. Log formats
22013----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022014
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022015HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022016and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
22017slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
22018options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022019
22020 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
22021 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
22022 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
22023 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
22024 extents.
22025
22026 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
22027 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
22028 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
22029 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
22030 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
22031
22032 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
22033 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
22034 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
22035 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
22036 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
22037
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020022038 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
22039 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
22040 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
22041 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
22042
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022043 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
22044
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022045Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
22046specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
22047field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
22048servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
22049always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
22050identifier.
22051
22052Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
22053 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
22054 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
22055 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
22056 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
22057
22058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220598.2.1. Default log format
22060-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022061
22062This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
22063as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
22064format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
22065
22066 Example :
22067 listen www
22068 mode http
22069 log global
22070 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22071
22072 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
22073 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
22074 (www/HTTP)
22075
22076 Field Format Extract from the example above
22077 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
22078 2 'Connect from' Connect from
22079 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
22080 4 'to' to
22081 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
22082 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
22083
22084Detailed fields description :
22085 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
22086 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
22087 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
22088 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
22089 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22090 and processed the connection.
22091 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
22092
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022093In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
22094"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
22095connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
22096
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022097It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
22098will eventually disappear.
22099
22100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221018.2.2. TCP log format
22102---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022103
22104The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
22105is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
22106information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
22107counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
22108emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
22109environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
22110the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
22111sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022112specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022113not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22114
22115The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22116exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022117if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable can be used instead.
22118Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022119
22120 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
22121 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
22122 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022123 # or using the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable
22124 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022125
22126A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
22127are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022128
22129 Example :
22130 frontend fnt
22131 mode tcp
22132 option tcplog
22133 log global
22134 default_backend bck
22135
22136 backend bck
22137 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22138
22139 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
22140 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
22141 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
22142
22143 Field Format Extract from the example above
22144 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
22145 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
22146 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
22147 4 frontend_name fnt
22148 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
22149 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
22150 7 bytes_read* 212
22151 8 termination_state --
22152 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
22153 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22154
22155Detailed fields description :
22156 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022157 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022158 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22159 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022160 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022161 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022162 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022163
22164 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022165 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22166 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22167 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022168
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022169 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022170 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
22171 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022172 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
22173 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
22174 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
22175 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022176
22177 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22178 and processed the connection.
22179
22180 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22181 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22182 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
22183 applications.
22184
22185 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22186 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22187 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22188 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
22189 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
22190
22191 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22192 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
22193 See "Timers" below for more details.
22194
22195 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22196 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
22197 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
22198 "Timers" below for more details.
22199
22200 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022201 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022202 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
22203 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
22204 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
22205 details.
22206
22207 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
22208 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
22209 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
22210 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
22211 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
22212
22213 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22214 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22215 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
22216 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
22217 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
22218 for more details.
22219
22220 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022221 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022222 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
22223 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
22224 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022225 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022226
22227 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22228 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22229 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22230 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22231 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22232 caused by a denial of service attack.
22233
22234 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22235 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22236 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22237 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22238 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22239 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22240 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22241 denial of service attack.
22242
22243 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22244 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22245 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22246 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22247 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22248 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22249 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22250 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
22251 be processed than on other servers.
22252
22253 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22254 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22255 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22256 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022257 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022258 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22259 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22260 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22261 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22262 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22263 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22264 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22265 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22266
22267 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22268 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22269 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22270 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22271 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22272 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022273 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022274 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22275
22276 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22277 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22278 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22279 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22280 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22281 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022282 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022283 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22284 occurs.
22285
22286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222878.2.3. HTTP log format
22288----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022289
22290The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
22291is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
22292the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
22293are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
22294emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
22295generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
22296"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
22297which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022298frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
22299is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022300
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022301The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22302exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022303if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22304instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022305
22306 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
22307 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22308 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
22309
22310And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
22311this exact string:
22312
22313 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
22314 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
22315 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
22316 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022317 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable
22318 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022319
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022320Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
22321slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
22322with a star ('*') after the field name below.
22323
22324 Example :
22325 frontend http-in
22326 mode http
22327 option httplog
22328 log global
22329 default_backend bck
22330
22331 backend static
22332 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22333
22334 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22335 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
22336 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022337 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022338
22339 Field Format Extract from the example above
22340 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22341 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022342 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022343 4 frontend_name http-in
22344 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022345 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022346 7 status_code 200
22347 8 bytes_read* 2750
22348 9 captured_request_cookie -
22349 10 captured_response_cookie -
22350 11 termination_state ----
22351 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22352 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22353 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22354 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22355 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022356
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022357Detailed fields description :
22358 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022359 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022360 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22361 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022362 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022363 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022364 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022365
22366 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022367 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22368 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22369 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022370
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022371 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022372 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022373
22374 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22375 and processed the connection.
22376
22377 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22378 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22379 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
22380
22381 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22382 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22383 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22384 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
22385 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
22386 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
22387
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022388 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
22389 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
22390 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022391 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022392 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
22393 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022394 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022395 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022396
22397 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22398 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022399 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022400
22401 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22402 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022403 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
22404 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022405
22406 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
22407 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
22408 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
22409 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
22410 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022411 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
22412 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022413
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022414 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022415 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
22416 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
22417 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
22418 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
22419 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
22420 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022421 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022422
22423 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022424 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
22425 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022426
22427 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
22428 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022429 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022430 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
22431 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
22432 overflowing.
22433
22434 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
22435 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
22436 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
22437 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
22438 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
22439 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
22440 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
22441 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
22442
22443 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
22444 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
22445 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
22446 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
22447 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
22448 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
22449 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
22450 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
22451
22452 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22453 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22454 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
22455 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
22456 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
22457 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
22458 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
22459
22460 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022461 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022462 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
22463 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
22464 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022465 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022466 system.
22467
22468 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22469 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22470 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22471 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22472 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22473 caused by a denial of service attack.
22474
22475 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22476 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22477 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22478 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22479 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22480 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22481 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22482 denial of service attack.
22483
22484 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22485 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22486 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22487 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22488 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22489 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22490 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22491 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
22492 processed than on other servers.
22493
22494 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22495 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22496 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22497 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022498 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022499 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22500 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22501 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22502 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22503 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22504 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22505 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22506 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22507
22508 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22509 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22510 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22511 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22512 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22513 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022514 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022515 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22516
22517 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22518 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22519 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22520 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22521 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22522 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022523 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022524 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22525 occurs.
22526
22527 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
22528 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
22529 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
22530 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
22531 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
22532 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
22533 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
22534 cookies" below for more details.
22535
22536 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
22537 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
22538 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
22539 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
22540 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
22541 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
22542 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
22543 and cookies" below for more details.
22544
22545 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
22546 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
22547 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
22548 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
22549 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
22550 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
22551 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
22552 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
22553
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022554
225558.2.4. HTTPS log format
22556----------------------
22557
22558The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
22559extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
22560information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
22561frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
22562end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
22563matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
22564sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
22565dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
22566"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22567
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022568The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22569exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022570if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22571instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022572
22573 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
22574 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22575 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
22576 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022577 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022578 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable
22579 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022580
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022581This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
22582appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
22583HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022584
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022585 Example :
22586 frontend https-in
22587 mode http
22588 option httpslog
22589 log global
22590 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
22591 default_backend bck
22592
22593 backend static
22594 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
22595
22596 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22597 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
22598 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022599 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
22600 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022601
22602 Field Format Extract from the example above
22603 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22604 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
22605 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
22606 4 frontend_name https-in
22607 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
22608 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
22609 7 status_code 200
22610 8 bytes_read* 2750
22611 9 captured_request_cookie -
22612 10 captured_response_cookie -
22613 11 termination_state ----
22614 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22615 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22616 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22617 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22618 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010022619 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020022620 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022621 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
22622 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022623
22624Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010022625 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
22626 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
22627 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022628
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020022629 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
22630 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
22631 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050022632 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020022633 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022634
22635 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
22636 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
22637 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
22638 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
22639
22640 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
22641 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
22642 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
22643 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
22644
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020022645 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
22646 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
22647 can be shared by multiple requests.
22648
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022649 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
22650 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
22651 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
22652 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
22653 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
22654
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022655 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
22656
22657 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
22658
22659
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100226608.2.5. Error log format
22661-----------------------
22662
22663When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
22664protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
22665unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
22666line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
22667"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
22668will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
22669logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
22670
22671The default format looks like this :
22672
22673 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
22674 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
22675 Connection error during SSL handshake
22676
22677 Field Format Extract from the example above
22678 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
22679 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
22680 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
22681 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
22682 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
22683
22684These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
22685failures.
22686
22687By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
22688above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
22689defined format.
22690
22691An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
22692source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
22693number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
22694internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
22695error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
22696the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
22697certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
22698indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
22699indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
22700ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
22701are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
22702would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
22703regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
22704
22705 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010022706 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010022707 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
22708 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
22709
22710
227118.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022712------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022713
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022714When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
22715ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
22716a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
22717formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
22718looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
22719and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022720
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022721HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022722Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
22723separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
22724prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
22725
22726Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
22727variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022728("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022729
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022730If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020022731as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022732less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
22733the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
22734
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020022735Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
22736"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
22737delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
22738preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022739
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022740Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
22741'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
22742https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
22743such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
22744
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022745Flags are :
22746 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022747 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022748 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
22749 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022750
22751 Example:
22752
22753 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
22754 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
22755
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022756 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
22757
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022758Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
22759
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022760 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022761 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022762 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
22763 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
22764 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022765 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
22766 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
22767 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022768 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022769 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000022770 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000022771 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000022772 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022773 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
22774 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010022775 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020022776 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022777 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010022778 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022779 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020022780 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080022781 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022782 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
22783 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
22784 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
22785 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
22786 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022787 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022788 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022789 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022790 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022791 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022792 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
22793 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022794 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22795 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
22796 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022797 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022798 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
22799 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022800 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022801 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22802 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
22803 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020022804 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020022805 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022806 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
22807 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
22808 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
22809 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020022810 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022811 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022812 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022813 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010022814 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022815 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022816 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
22817 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
22818 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022819 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022820 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
22821 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022822 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022823 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
22824 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020022825 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022826 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022827 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022828 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022829
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022830 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022831
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010022832
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228338.3. Advanced logging options
22834-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022835
22836Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
22837just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
22838options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
22839for more information about their usage.
22840
22841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228428.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
22843------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022844
22845It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022846HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022847commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
22848monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
22849ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
22850
22851 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
22852 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
22853 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
22854 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
22855
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020022856 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
22857 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022858
22859 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
22860 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
22861 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
22862
22863
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228648.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
22865----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022866
22867The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
22868what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
22869or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022870"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022871just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
22872log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
22873after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
22874is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
22875with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
22876with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
22877
22878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228798.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
22880------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022881
22882Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
22883for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
22884"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
22885retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
22886raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
22887a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
22888file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
22889you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
22890"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
22891
22892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228938.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
22894--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022895
22896Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
22897multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
22898them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
22899"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
22900logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
22901error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
22902and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
22903too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
22904useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
22905alternative.
22906
22907
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200229088.4. Timing events
22909------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022910
22911Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
22912reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
22913the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
22914frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022915mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
22916addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
22917
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022918Timings events in HTTP mode:
22919
22920 first request 2nd request
22921 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
22922 t tr t tr ...
22923 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
22924 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
22925 :<---- Tq ---->: :
22926 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022927 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022928 :<--------- Ta --------->:
22929
22930Timings events in TCP mode:
22931
22932 TCP session
22933 |<----------------->|
22934 t t
22935 ---|----|----|----|----|---
22936 | Th Tw Tc Td |
22937 |<------ Tt ------->|
22938
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022939 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022940 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022941 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
22942 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
22943 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022944 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022945 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
22946 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
22947 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
22948 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022949
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022950 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
22951 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
22952 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022953 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
22954 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
22955 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
22956 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
22957 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
22958 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022959
22960 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
22961 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
22962 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
22963 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
22964 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
22965 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
22966 request typed by hand during a test.
22967
22968 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
22969 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022970 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022971 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
22972 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
22973 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
22974 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022975
22976 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
22977 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
22978 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
22979 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
22980 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
22981
22982 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
22983 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
22984 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
22985 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
22986 connection never established.
22987
22988 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
22989 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
22990 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
22991 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
22992 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
22993 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
22994 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
22995 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
22996 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
22997 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
22998 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
22999
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023000 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
23001 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
23002 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
23003 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
23004 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
23005 by subtracting other timers when valid :
23006
23007 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
23008
23009 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
23010 "Ta" can never be negative.
23011
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023012 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
23013 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023014 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
23015 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023016 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023017
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023018 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023019
23020 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023021 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
23022 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023023
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023024 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
23025 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
23026 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
23027 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
23028 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
23029 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
23030 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
23031 prefixed with a '+' sign.
23032
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023033These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
23034protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
23035that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023036due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
23037"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
23038that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023039
23040Most common cases :
23041
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023042 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
23043 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
23044 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
23045 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
23046 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023047 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023048 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
23049 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
23050 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
23051 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
23052 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020023053 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023054
23055 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
23056 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
23057 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
23058 of ms on remote networks.
23059
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023060 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
23061 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
23062 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023063
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023064 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
23065 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023066 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023067 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
23068 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
23069 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
23070 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
23071 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
23072 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023073
23074Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
23075
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023076 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023077 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023078 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023079
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023080 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023081 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
23082 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
23083
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023084 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023085 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
23086 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
23087 flags.
23088
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023089 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
23090 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023091 Check the session termination flags, then check the
23092 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
23093 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
23094 the client connection was maintained open.
23095
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023096 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023097 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023098 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023099 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
23100
23101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200231028.5. Session state at disconnection
23103-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023104
23105TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
23106"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
231072-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
23108each of which has a special meaning :
23109
23110 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
23111 session to terminate :
23112
23113 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
23114
23115 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
23116 server explicitly refused it.
23117
23118 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
23119 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
23120 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
23121 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023122 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023123
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023124 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023125 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023126
23127 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
23128 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
23129 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
23130 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
23131 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
23132
23133 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
23134 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
23135 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
23136 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
23137 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
23138
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023139 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090023140 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
23141
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023142 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070023143 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
23144 backup connections when going up.
23145
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023146 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020023147
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023148 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
23149 send or receive data.
23150
23151 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
23152 send or receive data.
23153
23154 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
23155 with nothing left in the buffers.
23156
23157 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
23158
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010023159 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023160 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
23161
23162 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
23163 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
23164 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
23165 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
23166 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
23167
23168 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
23169 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
23170
23171 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
23172 server (HTTP only).
23173
23174 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
23175
23176 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
23177 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
23178 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
23179
23180 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
23181 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
23182 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
23183
23184 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
23185
23186 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
23187 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
23188
23189 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
23190 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
23191 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
23192
23193 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
23194 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020023195 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
23196 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023197
23198 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
23199 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
23200 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
23201 another server.
23202
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023203 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023204 server.
23205
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023206 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
23207 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
23208 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
23209 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23210
23211 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
23212 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
23213 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
23214 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23215
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020023216 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
23217 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
23218 "use-server" rule).
23219
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023220 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23221
23222 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
23223 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
23224
23225 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
23226
23227 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
23228 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
23229 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
23230
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023231 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
23232 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023233 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023234 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
23235 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
23236
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023237 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
23238
23239 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
23240 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
23241
23242 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
23243
23244 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23245
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023246The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
23247was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023248helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
23249starvation, attacks, etc...
23250
23251The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
23252alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
23253easier finding and understanding.
23254
23255 Flags Reason
23256
23257 -- Normal termination.
23258
23259 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023260 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
23261 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023262 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
23263
23264 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
23265 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023266 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
23267 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023268 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
23269 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023270
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023271 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23272 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023273 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023274
23275 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
23276 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
23277 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
23278
23279 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
23280 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
23281 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
23282 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
23283 the server takes too long to respond.
23284
23285 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
23286 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
23287 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
23288 long a time to respond.
23289
23290 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
23291 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
23292 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023293 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023294 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
23295 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023296
23297 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
23298 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
23299 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
23300 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
23301 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020023302 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023303 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
23304 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
23305 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
23306 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
23307 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
23308 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
23309 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
23310 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023311 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023312 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
23313 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
23314 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023315
23316 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
23317 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023318 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
23319 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
23320 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
23321 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023322
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023323 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023324 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
23325
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023326 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023327 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
23328 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023329 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023330 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
23331 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
23332
23333 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
23334 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
23335 503 or 504 here.
23336
23337 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023338 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023339 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
23340 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
23341 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
23342
23343 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23344 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023345 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023346 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023347 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023348
23349 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
23350 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
23351 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
23352 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
23353 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
23354 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023355 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023356
23357 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
23358 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
23359 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
23360 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
23361 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
23362 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
23363 solution is to fix the application.
23364
23365 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
23366 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
23367 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
23368 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
23369 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
23370 external attacks.
23371
23372 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070023373 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023374 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023375 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
23376 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
23377
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023378 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
23379 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
23380 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023381 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020023382 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023383
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023384 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
23385 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
23386 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
23387 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023388 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
23389 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
23390 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
23391 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023392 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
23393 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
23394 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
23395 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023396
23397 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
23398 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
23399 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023400 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
23401 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
23402 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
23403 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023404
23405 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
23406 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
23407 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
23408 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
23409
23410 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
23411 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
23412 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
23413 only be solved by proper system tuning.
23414
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023415The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023416persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023417important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
23418re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
23419
23420 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
23421
23422 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
23423 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
23424 set on a GET request.
23425
23426 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
23427 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023428 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023429 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
23430
23431 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
23432 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
23433 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
23434
23435 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
23436 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
23437 already got a cookie.
23438
23439 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
23440 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
23441 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
23442 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
23443 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
23444
23445 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
23446 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
23447 new cookie was inserted in the response.
23448
23449 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
23450 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
23451 new cookie was inserted in the response.
23452
23453 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
23454 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
23455
23456 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
23457 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
23458 then advertised in the response.
23459
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234618.6. Non-printable characters
23462-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023463
23464In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
23465consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
23466converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
23467prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
23468being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
23469escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
23470is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
23471'}' when logging headers.
23472
23473Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
23474issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
23475containing spaces is "User-Agent".
23476
23477Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
23478the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
23479performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
23480
23481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234828.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
23483---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023484
23485Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
23486achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023487section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023488cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
23489the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
23490the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023491locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023492not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
23493user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
23494a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
23495wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
23496
23497 Examples :
23498 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
23499 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
23500
23501 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
23502 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
23503
23504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235058.8. Capturing HTTP headers
23506---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023507
23508Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
23509proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
23510the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
23511server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
23512
23513Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
23514response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023515section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023516
23517It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010023518time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
23519appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023520are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
23521and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
23522follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
23523request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
23524in the logs.
23525
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020023526As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
23527frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
23528an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
23529
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023530 Example :
23531 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
23532 listen proxy-out
23533 mode http
23534 option httplog
23535 option logasap
23536 log global
23537 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
23538
23539 # log the name of the virtual server
23540 capture request header Host len 20
23541
23542 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
23543 capture request header Content-Length len 10
23544
23545 # log the beginning of the referrer
23546 capture request header Referer len 20
23547
23548 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
23549 capture response header Server len 20
23550
23551 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
23552 capture response header Content-Length len 10
23553
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023554 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023555 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
23556
23557 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
23558 capture response header Via len 20
23559
23560 # log the URL location during a redirection
23561 capture response header Location len 20
23562
23563 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
23564 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
23565 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23566 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
23567 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
23568
23569 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
23570 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
23571 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23572 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023573 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023574
23575 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
23576 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
23577 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23578 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
23579 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023580 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023581
23582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235838.9. Examples of logs
23584---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023585
23586These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
23587them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
23588reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
23589
23590 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
23591 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
23592 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
23593
23594 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
23595 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
23596
23597 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
23598 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
23599 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
23600
23601 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
23602 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
23603
23604 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
23605 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
23606 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
23607
23608 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010023609 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023610 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
23611 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
23612
23613 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
23614 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
23615 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
23616
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020023617 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
23618 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
23619 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
23620 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023621 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020023622 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023623
23624 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023625 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023626
23627 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
23628 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
23629 Nothing was sent to any server.
23630
23631 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
23632 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
23633
23634 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
23635 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023636 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023637 send a 408 return code to the client.
23638
23639 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
23640 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
23641
23642 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
23643 5 seconds ("c----").
23644
23645 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
23646 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023647 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023648
23649 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023650 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023651 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
23652 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
23653 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
23654 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
23655 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010023656
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020023657
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200236589. Supported filters
23659--------------------
23660
23661Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
23662accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
23663unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
23664
23665See also : "filter"
23666
236679.1. Trace
23668----------
23669
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010023670filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023671
23672 Arguments:
23673 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
23674 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
23675
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010023676 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023677
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023678 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023679 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
23680 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
23681 amount of the parsed data.
23682
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023683 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010023684
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023685This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
23686callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
23687information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
23688filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
23689
23690Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
23691tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
23692a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
23693
23694
236959.2. HTTP compression
23696---------------------
23697
23698filter compression
23699
23700The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
23701keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023702when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
23703fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
23704done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
23705explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
23706filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
23707listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23708order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023709
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023710See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
23711 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023712
23713
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200237149.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
23715--------------------------------------------
23716
23717filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
23718
23719 Arguments :
23720
23721 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
23722 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
23723 parsed.
23724
23725 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
23726 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
23727 part must be placed in its own scope.
23728
23729The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
23730external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023731streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023732exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
23733also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
23734
23735SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
23736the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
23737
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010023738For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023739"doc/SPOE.txt".
23740
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100237419.4. Cache
23742----------
23743
23744filter cache <name>
23745
23746 Arguments :
23747
23748 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
23749
23750The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
23751"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023752cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023753other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
23754case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
23755is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
23756filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010023757listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23758order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010023759
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023760See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
23761 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
23762
23763
237649.5. Fcgi-app
23765-------------
23766
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040023767filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023768
23769 Arguments :
23770
23771 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
23772
23773The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
23774request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
23775reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
23776used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
23777implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
23778used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
23779fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
23780used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23781order.
23782
23783See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
23784 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
23785
23786
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100237879.6. OpenTracing
23788----------------
23789
23790The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
23791HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
23792of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
23793Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
23794
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023795This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023796
23797The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
23798HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
23799participates in the work of HAProxy.
23800
23801filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
23802
23803 Arguments :
23804
23805 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
23806 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
23807 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
23808 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
23809 OpenTracing filters.
23810
23811 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
23812 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
23813 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
23814 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
23815 filter must have its own scope defined.
23816
23817More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020023818of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023819
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200238209.7. Bandwidth limitation
23821--------------------------
23822
23823filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23824filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23825filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23826filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23827
23828 Arguments :
23829
23830 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
23831 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
23832
23833 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
23834 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23835 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23836 expressed in bytes.
23837
23838 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
23839 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
23840 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
23841 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23842
23843 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
23844 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
23845 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23846
23847 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050023848 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023849 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
23850 is expressed in milliseconds.
23851
23852 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
23853 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
23854 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23855 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23856 expressed in bytes.
23857
23858Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
23859speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
23860bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
23861used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
23862sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
23863other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
23864connections for a given client.
23865
23866The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
23867filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
23868definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
23869the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
23870compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
23871the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
23872for the cache filter.
23873
23874There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
23875default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050023876to enforce a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023877the table.
23878
23879In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
23880limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
23881forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
23882the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
23883used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
23884cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
23885level.
23886
23887The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
23888connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
23889of the same connection may have different limits.
23890
23891For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
23892defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
23893bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
23894only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
23895when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
23896
23897For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
23898incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
23899corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
23900stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
23901used to limit outgoing data.
23902
23903Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
23904limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
23905to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
23906carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
23907it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
23908limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
23909experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
23910a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
23911start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
23912some experimentations.
23913
23914 Example:
23915 frontend http
23916 bind *:80
23917 mode http
23918
23919 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
23920 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
23921 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
23922
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050023923 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023924 # independently of all other streams.
23925 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
23926
23927 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
23928 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
23929 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
23930 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
23931 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
23932 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
23933 ...
23934
23935 backend limit-by-src
23936 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
23937 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
23938
23939See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
23940 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
23941 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
23942 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023943
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002394410. FastCGI applications
23945-------------------------
23946
23947HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
23948feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
23949the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
23950FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
23951servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
23952FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
23953backend.
23954
23955HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
23956application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
23957connection.
23958
2395910.1. Setup
23960-----------
23961
2396210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
23963--------------------------
23964
23965fcgi-app <name>
23966 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
23967 document root must be defined.
23968
23969acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
23970 Declare or complete an access list.
23971
23972 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
23973 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
23974 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
23975 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
23976 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
23977
23978docroot <path>
23979 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
23980 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
23981 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
23982
23983index <script-name>
23984 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
23985 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
23986 is an optional setting.
23987
23988 Example :
23989 index index.php
23990
23991log-stderr global
23992log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010023993 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023994 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
23995
23996 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
23997 default STDERR messages are ignored.
23998
23999pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24000 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
24001 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
24002 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24003
24004 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
24005 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
24006 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
24007 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
24008
24009 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
24010 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
24011
24012path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024013 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024014 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
24015 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
24016 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
24017 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
24018 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
24019 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
24020 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024021
24022 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024023 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024024 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
24025 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
24026 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
24027 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024028
24029 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024030 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
24031 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024032
24033option get-values
24034no option get-values
24035 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
24036
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024037 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024038 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
24039
24040 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
24041 application will accept.
24042
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020024043 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
24044 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024045
24046 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050024047 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024048 option is disabled.
24049
24050 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
24051 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
24052 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
24053 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
24054 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
24055 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
24056
24057option keep-conn
24058no option keep-conn
24059 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
24060 sending a response.
24061
24062 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
24063 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
24064
24065option max-reqs <reqs>
24066 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
24067 accept.
24068
24069 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
24070 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
24071 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
24072 to 1.
24073
24074option mpxs-conns
24075no option mpxs-conns
24076 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
24077
24078 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
24079 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
24080
24081set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24082 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
24083 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
24084 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
24085 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24086
24087 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
24088 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
24089 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
24090
24091 Example :
24092 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
24093 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
24094
24095 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
24096
24097
2409810.1.2. Proxy section
24099---------------------
24100
24101use-fcgi-app <name>
24102 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
24103
24104 Arguments :
24105 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
24106
24107 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
24108 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
24109 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
24110 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
24111 application may be defined at a time per backend.
24112
24113 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
24114 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
24115 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
24116 application are evaluated.
24117
24118
2411910.1.3. Example
24120---------------
24121
24122 frontend front-http
24123 mode http
24124 bind *:80
24125 bind *:
24126
24127 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
24128 default_backend back-static
24129
24130 backend back-static
24131 mode http
24132 server www A.B.C.D:80
24133
24134 backend back-dynamic
24135 mode http
24136 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
24137 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
24138
24139 fcgi-app php-fpm
24140 log-stderr global
24141 option keep-conn
24142
24143 docroot /var/www/my-app
24144 index index.php
24145 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
24146
24147
2414810.2. Default parameters
24149------------------------
24150
24151A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
24152the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024153script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024154applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
24155
24156 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24157 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
24158 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
24159 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
24160 | | |
24161 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24162 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
24163 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
24164 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
24165 | | application. |
24166 | | |
24167 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24168 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
24169 | | the request. It may not be set. |
24170 | | |
24171 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24172 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
24173 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
24174 | | the application's configuration. |
24175 | | |
24176 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24177 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
24178 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
24179 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
24180 | | |
24181 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24182 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
24183 | | following the part that identifies the script |
24184 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
24185 | | be defined. |
24186 | | |
24187 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24188 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
24189 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
24190 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
24191 | | is not set too. |
24192 | | |
24193 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24194 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
24195 | | set. |
24196 | | |
24197 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24198 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
24199 | | the request. |
24200 | | |
24201 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24202 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
24203 | | client as part of user authentication. |
24204 | | |
24205 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24206 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
24207 | | script to process the request. |
24208 | | |
24209 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24210 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
24211 | | |
24212 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24213 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
24214 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
24215 | | |
24216 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24217 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
24218 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
24219 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
24220 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
24221 | | |
24222 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24223 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
24224 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
24225 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
24226 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
24227 | | side. |
24228 | | |
24229 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24230 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
24231 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
24232 | | connected to. |
24233 | | |
24234 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24235 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
24236 | | |
24237 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020024238 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
24239 | | current HAProxy version. |
24240 | | |
24241 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024242 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
24243 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
24244 | | |
24245 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24246
24247
2424810.3. Limitations
24249------------------
24250
24251The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
24252way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
24253during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
24254establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
24255application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
24256or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
24257message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
24258these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
24259and HTTP servers under the same backend.
24260
24261Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
24262request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
24263requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
24264
24265About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
24266into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
24267fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
24268"http-request" ones.
24269
24270Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
24271FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
24272processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
24273must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
24274here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010024275
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024276
2427711. Address formats
24278-------------------
24279
24280Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
24281address.
24282
24283This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
24284The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
24285of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
24286equivalent is '::'.
24287
24288Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
24289is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
24290
24291This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
24292family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
24293
24294Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
24295configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
24296use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
24297'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
24298
24299Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
24300socket type and the transport method.
24301
24302
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002430311.1. Address family prefixes
24304-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024305
24306'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
24307
24308'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
24309 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
24310 listening.
24311
24312'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
24313 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
24314 on the statement using this address, a port or
24315 a port range may or must be specified.
24316
24317'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24318 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
24319 using this address, a port or a port range
24320 may or must be specified.
24321
24322'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24323 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
24324 using this address, a port or a port range
24325 may or must be specified.
24326
24327'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
24328 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
24329 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
24330 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
24331 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
24332 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
24333
24334'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
24335 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
24336 start by slash '/'.
24337
24338
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002433911.2. Socket type prefixes
24340--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024341
24342Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
24343type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
24344this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
24345This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
24346but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
24347
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024348Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should instead use
24349use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes". However these can
24350sometimes be convenient, for example in combination with inherited sockets
24351known by their file descriptor number, in which case the address family is "fd"
24352and the socket type must be declared.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024353
24354If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
24355they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
24356report this to the maintainers.
24357
24358'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24359 to "stream"
24360
24361'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24362 to "datagram".
24363
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024364'quic+<family>@<address>' forces socket type to "datagram" and transport
24365 method to "stream".
24366
24367
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024368
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002436911.3. Protocol prefixes
24370-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024371
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024372'quic4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24373 an IPv4 address but socket type is forced to
24374 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
24375 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
24376 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024377 must be specified. It is equivalent to
24378 "quic+ipv4@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024379
24380'quic6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24381 an IPv6 address but socket type is forced to
24382 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
24383 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
24384 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024385 must be specified. It is equivalent to
24386 "quic+ipv6@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024387
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024388'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24389 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24390 socket type and transport method is forced to
24391 "stream". Depending on the statement using
24392 this address, a port or a port range can or
24393 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24394 of 'stream+ip@'.
24395
24396'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24397 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24398 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24399 statement using this address, a port or port
24400 range can or must be specified.
24401 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24402
24403'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24404 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24405 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24406 statement using this address, a port or port
24407 range can or must be specified.
24408 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24409
24410'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24411 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24412 socket type and transport method is forced to
24413 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
24414 this address, a port or a port range can or
24415 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24416 of 'dgram+ip@'.
24417
24418'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24419 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24420 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
24421 the statement using this address, a port or
24422 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010024423 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024424
24425'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24426 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24427 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
24428 the statement using this address, a port or
24429 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010024430 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024431
24432'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
24433 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
24434 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
24435
24436'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
24437 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
24438 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
24439
24440In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
24441QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
24442
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010024443/*
24444 * Local variables:
24445 * fill-column: 79
24446 * End:
24447 */